]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
(imenu--generic-function): Skip matches in comments.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 See the end for copying conditions.
4
5 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
6 For older news, see the file ONEWS
7 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
8 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
9
10 Temporary note:
11 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
12 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
13 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
14 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
15
16 \f
17 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
18
19 ** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
20 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
21 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
22 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
23
24 ---
25 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
26 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
27 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
28 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
29 select the right one.
30
31 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
32 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
33 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
34
35 ---
36 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
37
38 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
39
40 ---
41 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
42 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
43 installed programs.
44
45 ---
46 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
47 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
48 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
49 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
50 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
51 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
52 in each user's home directory.
53
54 ---
55 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
56 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
57 Emacs with Leim.
58
59 +++
60 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
61
62 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
63 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
64 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
65 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
66
67 ---
68 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
69 the distribution.
70
71 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
72 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
73 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
74 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
75
76 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
77
78 ---
79 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
80
81 ---
82 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
83
84 ---
85 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
86 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
87
88 ---
89 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
90
91 ---
92 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
93
94 ---
95 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
96 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
97
98 \f
99 * Changes in Emacs 21.4
100
101 +++
102 ** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
103 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
104 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
105
106 +++
107 ** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
108 `progress-reporter-force-update' and `progress-reporter-done' provide
109 a simple and efficient way of printing progress messages to the user.
110
111 +++
112 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
113 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
114 and `C-c C-r'.
115
116 +++
117 ** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
118 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
119
120 +++
121 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
122 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
123
124 ** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
125
126 +++
127 ** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
128 for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
129 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
130 specified by the syntax table.
131
132 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
133 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
134 existing values. For example:
135
136 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
137
138 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
139 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
140
141 ** New features in evaluation commands
142
143 +++
144 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
145 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
146
147 *** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
148 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
149 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
150 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
151 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
152
153 ** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
154 characters.
155
156 ** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
157 in the current input method to input a character at point.
158
159 ** Convenient commands to switch buffers in a cyclic order are C-x <left>
160 (prev-buffer) and C-x <right> (next-buffer).
161
162 ** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
163 C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
164
165 ** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
166 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
167 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
168 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
169
170 ---
171 ** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
172 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
173 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
174 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
175 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
176
177 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
178 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
179
180 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
181 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
182 lines, including any prompts.
183
184 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
185 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
186 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
187 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
188 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
189 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
190 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
191
192 ** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
193 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
194
195 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
196
197 +++
198 ** New command line option -Q.
199
200 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
201 the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
202 cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
203
204 ** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
205 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
206
207 ** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
208 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
209 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
210
211 ** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
212 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
213 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
214 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
215 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
216 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
217 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
218 be mode dependent.
219
220 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
221 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
222 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
223 toggles this mode.
224
225 ** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
226 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
227 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
228 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
229 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
230 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
231 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
232 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
233 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
234
235 ** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
236 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
237 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
238 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
239 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
240
241 ** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
242 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
243 mode.
244
245 ** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
246
247 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
248 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
249 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
250 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
251
252 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
253 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
254 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
255
256 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
257 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
258 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
259 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
260 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
261
262 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
263
264 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
265
266 +++
267 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
268 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
269 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
270 subprocesses inherit.
271
272 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
273
274 *** There's a new separate package grep.el.
275
276 *** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
277
278 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
279 can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
280
281 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
282
283 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
284 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
285 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
286
287 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
288 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
289 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
290 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
291 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
292 source line is highlighted.
293
294 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
295 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
296 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
297 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
298 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
299 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
300 file.
301
302 ** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
303 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
304 in new face `next-error'.
305
306 ** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
307 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
308 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
309 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
310 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
311 C-c C-f.
312
313 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
314
315 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
316 resync points in both windows.
317
318 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
319 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
320 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
321 using strokes as an input method.
322
323 ** Gnus package
324
325 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
326 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
327 PGP/MIME.
328
329 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
330 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
331
332 +++
333 ** Desktop package
334
335 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
336 desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
337 saving.
338
339 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
340 buffer list.
341
342 *** New commands:
343 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
344 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
345 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
346 it was loaded.
347
348 *** New customizable variables:
349 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
350 killed.
351 - desktop-file-name-format.
352 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
353 - desktop-locals-to-save.
354 - desktop-globals-to-clear.
355 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp.
356
357 *** New command line option --no-desktop
358
359 *** New hooks:
360 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
361 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
362
363 ---
364 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
365 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
366 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
367 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
368 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
369 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
370 feature.
371
372 ** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
373
374 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
375 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
376 % emacsclient -s foo file1
377 % emacsclient -s bar file2
378
379 +++
380 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
381 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
382 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
383 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
384 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
385
386 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
387 revert to the old behaviour of continuing such lines.
388
389 +++
390 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
391 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
392 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
393 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
394
395 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
396 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
397 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
398
399 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
400 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
401
402 Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
403 of each bitmap individually.
404
405 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
406 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
407 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
408 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
409
410 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
411 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
412 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
413 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
414 keyboard oriented alternative.
415
416 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
417 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
418 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
419 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
420 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
421
422 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
423 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
424 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
425 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
426
427 +++
428 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
429 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
430 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
431 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
432 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
433 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
434 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
435
436 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
437 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
438
439 +++
440 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
441 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
442 an interactively callable function.
443
444
445 ** sql changes.
446
447 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
448 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
449 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
450 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
451 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
452
453 The following values are supported:
454
455 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
456 db2 DB2
457 informix Informix
458 ingres Ingres
459 interbase Interbase
460 linter Linter
461 ms Microsoft
462 mysql MySQL
463 oracle Oracle
464 postgres Postgres
465 solid Solid
466 sqlite SQLite
467 sybase Sybase
468
469 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
470 SQL mode indicator.
471
472 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
473 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
474 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
475
476 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
477
478 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
479 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
480 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
481 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
482
483 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
484 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
485
486 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
487 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
488 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
489
490 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
491 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
492 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
493 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
494 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
495 terminated.
496
497 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
498 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
499 credentials to authenticate the user.
500
501 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
502 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
503 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
504
505 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
506 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
507
508 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
509 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
510 defaults.
511
512 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
513 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
514 `sql-product'.
515
516 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
517 with special modes such as Tar mode.
518
519 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
520
521 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
522 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
523 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
524 available.
525
526 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
527 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
528 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
529 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
530 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
531 matching item.
532
533 +++
534 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
535 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
536 the operating system or your X server.
537
538 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
539 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
540 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
541
542 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
543 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
544
545 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
546 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
547
548 ** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
549 list starting after point.
550
551 ** Dired mode:
552
553 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
554 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
555 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
556
557 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
558 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
559
560 +++
561 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
562 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
563
564 +++
565 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
566 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
567 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
568 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
569 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
570 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
571
572 +++
573 *** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
574 types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
575 what external viewers to use and when.
576
577 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
578 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
579
580 +++
581 ** Dired-x:
582
583 *** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
584 command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
585 marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
586 mode toggling function instead.
587
588 ** Info mode:
589
590 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
591 with the number appended to the *info* buffer name.
592
593 *** Regexp isearch (C-M-s and C-M-r) can search through multiple nodes.
594 Failed isearch wraps to the top/final node.
595
596 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
597 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
598 search without prompting for a new search string.
599
600 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
601
602 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
603 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
604
605 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
606 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
607 possible matches.
608
609 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
610 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
611 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
612
613 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
614 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
615
616 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
617 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
618
619 +++
620 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
621 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
622 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
623
624 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
625 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
626 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
627 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
628
629 +++
630 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
631
632 ---
633 *** Info-index offers completion.
634
635 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
636 'sql-sqlite'.
637
638 ** BibTeX mode:
639 *** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
640 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2 on clickable fields).
641 *** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
642 an existing BibTeX entry.
643 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
644 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
645 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
646 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
647 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
648 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
649 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
650
651 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
652 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
653
654 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
655 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
656
657 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
658 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
659
660 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
661 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
662
663 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
664 locate entries and crossref'd entries.
665
666 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
667 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
668
669 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
670 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
671 at the edges of the window.
672
673 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
674 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
675
676 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
677 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
678 or when the frame is resized.
679
680 ** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
681
682 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
683 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
684
685 ---
686 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
687 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
688 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
689
690 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
691
692 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
693 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
694
695 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
696 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
697
698 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
699
700 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
701 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
702
703 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
704 Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
705
706 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
707
708 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
709 and other common debugger commands.
710
711 ** recentf changes.
712
713 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
714 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
715 automatic cleanup.
716
717 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
718 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
719 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
720 recent list with different symbolic links.
721
722 To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
723 and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
724 misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
725 `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
726 aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
727
728 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
729 from the locale.
730
731 ** Init file changes
732
733 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
734 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
735
736 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
737
738 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
739 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
740 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
741 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
742 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
743 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
744
745 ** MH-E changes.
746
747 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
748 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
749
750 +++
751 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
752 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
753 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
754
755 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
756
757 +++
758 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
759 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
760 appears between the position information and the major mode.
761
762 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
763 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
764
765 +++
766 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
767 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
768 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
769 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
770 set-fringe-style.
771
772 +++
773 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
774 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
775 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
776 "~/".
777
778 +++
779 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
780 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
781 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
782 file.)
783
784 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
785 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
786
787 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
788 of a file.
789
790 ---
791 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
792
793 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
794 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
795 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
796
797 ---
798 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
799 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
800 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
801
802 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
803 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
804 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
805 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
806 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
807
808 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
809 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
810 t, and the status is shown.
811
812 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
813 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
814
815 +++
816 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
817 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
818 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
819 faces.
820
821 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
822 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
823 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
824 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
825 automatically according to the locale.)
826
827 ** Indian support has been updated.
828 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
829 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
830 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
831 supported.
832
833 ---
834 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
835 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
836 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
837 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
838 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
839 tamil-inscript.
840
841 ---
842 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
843 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
844 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
845
846 ---
847 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
848 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
849 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
850 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
851 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
852 latter is used by GNU locales.
853
854 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
855 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
856 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
857 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
858 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
859 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
860 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
861 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
862 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
863 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
864 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
865 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
866
867 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
868 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
869 fontset appropriately.
870
871 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
872 unicode.
873
874 +++
875 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
876 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
877 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
878 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
879 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
880 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
881 mule-unicode-... ones.
882
883 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
884 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
885 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
886 possible.
887
888 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
889 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
890 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
891 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
892 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
893
894 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
895 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
896 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
897 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
898
899 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
900 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
901 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
902 command.
903
904 ---
905 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
906 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
907 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
908
909 ---
910 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
911 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+ and W32).
912
913 ---
914 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif pops down when pressing ESC.
915
916 +++
917 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
918 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
919
920 +++
921 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
922 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
923 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
924 cursor does.
925
926 +++
927 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
928 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
929
930 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
931 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
932 program files that include other program files.
933
934 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
935 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
936 in them.
937
938 ---
939 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
940 when Emacs visits them.
941
942 ---
943 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
944
945 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
946 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
947 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
948
949 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
950 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
951 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
952 and use the more appropriately result.
953
954 +++
955 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
956 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
957 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
958 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
959
960 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
961 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
962 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
963 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
964 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
965 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
966
967 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
968 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
969
970 ** TeX modes:
971 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
972 +++
973 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
974 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
975 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
976 TeX commands to use at startup.
977 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
978 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
979
980 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
981
982 +++
983 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
984 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
985 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
986 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
987 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
988 feature is not enabled.
989
990 ** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
991 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
992 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
993 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
994 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
995 to give it focus.
996
997 +++
998 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
999 description various information about a character, including its
1000 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1001 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1002 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
1003
1004 +++
1005 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1006 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1007 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1008 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1009 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1010
1011 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1012 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1013 in Indented-Text mode.
1014
1015 ** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1016 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1017 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1018
1019 ** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1020 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1021 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1022 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
1023 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1024 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1025 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1026 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1027 can be edited for each replacement.
1028
1029 +++
1030 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1031 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1032 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1033 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1034 also disable mouse highlighting.
1035
1036 ** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1037 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1038 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1039
1040 +++
1041 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1042 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1043 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1044 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1045 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1046
1047 +++
1048 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1049 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1050 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1051 prompt string.
1052
1053 +++
1054 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1055 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1056 the mode line of the currently selected window.
1057
1058 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1059 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1060
1061 ---
1062 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
1063 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1064 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1065 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1066 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1067 current date and time, current line and column number in the
1068 mode-line.
1069
1070 ---
1071 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1072
1073 +++
1074 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
1075 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
1076 `display-time-mail-directory'.
1077
1078 ---
1079 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1080
1081 +++
1082 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
1083 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
1084 argument it toggles the mode.
1085
1086 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1087 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1088
1089 +++
1090 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1091 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1092 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1093 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1094 `inhibit-splash-screen').
1095
1096 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1097
1098 +++
1099 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1100 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1101 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1102 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1103 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1104 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1105 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1106 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1107 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1108
1109 ---
1110 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1111 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1112 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1113 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1114 all of these colors.
1115
1116 +++
1117 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1118 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1119 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1120 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1121 colors as on X.
1122
1123 ---
1124 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1125
1126 +++
1127 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1128
1129 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1130 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1131 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
1132 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
1133
1134 ---
1135 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
1136 automatically.
1137
1138 +++
1139 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1140 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1141 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1142 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1143
1144 +++
1145 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
1146
1147 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1148
1149 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1150 that do not change:
1151
1152 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1153 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1154
1155 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1156 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1157
1158 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1159
1160 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1161 run by the key sequence.
1162
1163 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1164 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1165 that command.
1166
1167 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
1168 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
1169
1170 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1171 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1172
1173 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1174 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1175
1176 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1177 new-kill-line is on C-k
1178
1179 +++
1180 ** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1181 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1182 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1183 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1184 for details.
1185
1186 +++
1187 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1188 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1189 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1190 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1191
1192 +++
1193 ** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1194 at the end of a line.
1195
1196 +++
1197 ** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1198 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1199 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1200
1201 +++
1202 ** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1203 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1204 search string used as the string to replace.
1205
1206 +++
1207 ** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1208 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1209 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
1210
1211 +++
1212 ** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1213 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1214 elements are deleted.
1215
1216 +++
1217 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1218 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1219 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1220 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1221
1222 +++
1223 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1224 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1225 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1226 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1227
1228 +++
1229 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1230 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1231 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1232 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1233 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1234 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1235
1236 ---
1237 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1238 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1239 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1240 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1241 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1242 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1243 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1244
1245 +++
1246 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1247 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1248 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1249 under the "[State]" button.
1250
1251 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1252 point (no integers are allowed).
1253
1254 +++
1255 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
1256 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1257
1258 ---
1259 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
1260
1261 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1262 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1263 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1264 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1265 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1266
1267 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1268 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1269 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1270 (gud-finish).
1271
1272 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1273 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1274
1275 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1276 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1277 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1278
1279 Added Customization Variables
1280
1281 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1282
1283 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1284 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1285 java sources (previous method).
1286
1287 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1288 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1289 is nil).
1290
1291 Minor Improvements
1292
1293 *** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1294 instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
1295 compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
1296 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1297 "starttls" tool).
1298
1299 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1300
1301 +++
1302 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1303 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
1304 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
1305
1306 +++
1307 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1308 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1309 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1310 is only rarely needed.
1311
1312 ---
1313 ** JIT-lock changes
1314 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
1315
1316 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
1317 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
1318 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1319 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
1320
1321 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1322
1323 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1324 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1325 refontification takes place.
1326
1327 +++
1328 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1329 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
1330 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1331 you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1332 This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
1333 a key.
1334
1335 +++
1336 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1337 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1338 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1339 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
1340 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1341 command only.
1342
1343 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1344 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1345 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1346 mark or the region.
1347
1348 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1349 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1350 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1351 C-g.
1352
1353 +++
1354 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
1355 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
1356 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1357
1358 +++
1359 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1360 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1361 switching to it.
1362
1363 +++
1364 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1365 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1366 affects the initial frame.
1367
1368 +++
1369 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1370 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
1371 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1372 paragraphs.
1373
1374 +++
1375 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1376 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1377 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1378 directory listing into a buffer.
1379
1380 ---
1381 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1382 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1383
1384 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1385 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1386 This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1387 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1388
1389 +++
1390 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1391 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1392 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1393 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1394 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1395 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1396 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1397 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1398
1399 +++
1400 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
1401 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1402 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1403 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
1404 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
1405
1406 +++
1407 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1408 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1409 appears in.
1410
1411 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1412 of the recognized cursor types.
1413
1414 ---
1415 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1416 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1417 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1418
1419 +++
1420 ** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1421 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1422
1423 +++
1424 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1425 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
1426 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
1427 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1428 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1429 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1430 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1431 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1432 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1433
1434 +++
1435 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1436 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1437 count backward from the end of the year.
1438
1439 +++
1440 ** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1441 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1442 day of that ISO week.
1443
1444 ---
1445 ** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
1446 arguments, and only report on the specified holiday rather than all.
1447 This makes customization of the variable `christian-holidays' simpler,
1448 but existing customizations may need to be updated.
1449
1450 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1451 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1452 and `diary-header-line-format'.
1453
1454 +++
1455 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1456 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1457 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1458 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1459
1460 ** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1461 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1462 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1463 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1464 formats.
1465
1466
1467 ** VC Changes
1468
1469 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1470 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1471 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1472 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1473 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1474
1475 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1476
1477 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1478
1479 +++
1480 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1481 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1482 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1483 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1484 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1485 CVS.
1486
1487 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1488
1489 ** EDiff changes.
1490
1491 +++
1492 *** When comparing directories.
1493 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1494 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1495 from one directory to another.
1496
1497 +++
1498 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1499 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1500 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1501 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1502 comparison.
1503
1504 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1505 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1506 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1507
1508 +++
1509 ** Etags changes.
1510
1511 *** New regular expressions features
1512
1513 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1514 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1515 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1516 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1517 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1518 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1519 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1520 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1521 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1522 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1523 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1524
1525 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1526 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1527 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1528 CR, TAB, VT,
1529
1530 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1531 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1532 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1533 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1534
1535 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1536 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1537 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1538
1539 *** New language parsing features
1540
1541 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1542 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1543
1544 **** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1545
1546 **** New language HTML.
1547 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1548 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1549
1550 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1551 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1552 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1553
1554 **** New language Lua.
1555 All functions are tagged.
1556
1557 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1558 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1559 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1560 package::sub.
1561
1562 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1563
1564 **** New language PHP.
1565 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1566 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
1567
1568 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1569 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1570 renewenvironment.
1571
1572 *** Honour #line directives.
1573 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1574 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1575 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1576 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1577 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1578
1579 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1580 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1581 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1582 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
1583 the file FILE.
1584
1585 +++
1586 ** CC Mode changes.
1587
1588 *** Font lock support.
1589 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1590 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1591 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1592 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1593 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1594 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1595
1596 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1597 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1598 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1599 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1600 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1601 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1602 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1603 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1604 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1605
1606 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1607 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1608 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1609 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1610 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1611 take the better part of a minute.
1612
1613 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1614 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1615 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1616 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1617 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1618 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1619
1620 **** Support for documentation comments.
1621 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1622 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1623 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1624 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1625
1626 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1627 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1628 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1629 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1630
1631 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1632 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1633 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1634 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1635 parens.
1636
1637 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1638 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1639 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1640 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1641 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1642
1643 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1644 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1645 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1646 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1647 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1648
1649 *** Support for the AWK language.
1650 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1651 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1652 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1653 Here is a summary:
1654
1655 **** Indentation Engine
1656 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1657
1658 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1659 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1660 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1661 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1662 definition, or structured statement.
1663
1664 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1665 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1666 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1667
1668 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1669 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1670 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1671 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1672
1673 **** Font Locking
1674 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1675 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1676 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1677 the AWK language itself.
1678
1679 **** Comment Commands
1680 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1681 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1682
1683 **** Movement Commands
1684 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1685 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1686 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1687
1688 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1689 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1690 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1691 functions.
1692
1693 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1694 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1695 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1696 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1697
1698 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1699 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1700 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1701 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1702 composition-close, and incomposition.
1703
1704 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1705 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1706 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1707 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1708
1709 *** Better control over require-final-newline.
1710 The variable that controls how to handle a final newline when the
1711 buffer is saved, require-final-newline, is now customizable on a
1712 per-mode basis through c-require-final-newline. The default is to set
1713 it to t only in languages that mandate a final newline in source files
1714 (C, C++ and Objective-C).
1715
1716 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1717 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1718 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1719 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1720 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1721
1722 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1723
1724 is now analysed as
1725
1726 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1727
1728 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1729 symbol.
1730
1731 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1732 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1733 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1734 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
1735
1736 *** API changes for derived modes.
1737 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1738 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1739 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1740 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1741 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1742
1743 **** New language variable system.
1744 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1745
1746 **** New initialization functions.
1747 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1748 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1749 c-init-language-vars.
1750
1751 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1752 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1753 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1754 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1755
1756 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1757 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1758 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1759 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1760 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1761
1762 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1763 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1764 its substatement. E.g:
1765
1766 if (x)
1767 x_is_true:
1768 do_stuff();
1769
1770 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
1771
1772 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1773 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1774 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1775 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1776 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1777 inside #define's.
1778
1779 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1780 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1781 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1782 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1783 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1784 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1785 empty lines within the macro better.
1786
1787 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1788 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1789 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1790
1791 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1792 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1793 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1794 backslashes can be moved.
1795
1796 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1797 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1798 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1799 inserted in auto-newline mode.
1800
1801 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1802 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1803 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1804 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1805 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1806 backslash) in the macro.
1807
1808 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1809 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1810 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1811 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1812 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1813 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
1814
1815 *** New function c-context-open-line.
1816 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1817
1818 *** New lineup functions
1819
1820 **** c-lineup-string-cont
1821 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1822 continues. E.g:
1823
1824 result = prefix + "A message "
1825 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1826
1827 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1828 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1829
1830 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1831 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1832 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1833
1834 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1835 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1836 Ryde.
1837
1838 **** c-lineup-argcont
1839 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1840 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1841
1842 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1843 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1844 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1845 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1846 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1847 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1848
1849 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1850 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1851 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1852 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1853 context.
1854
1855 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1856 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1857 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1858 happen when macros are involved.
1859
1860 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1861 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1862 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1863 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1864 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1865 line is left untouched.
1866
1867 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1868 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1869 syntactic indentation.
1870
1871 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
1872 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
1873
1874 +++
1875 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
1876 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
1877
1878 +++
1879 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1880 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1881 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1882
1883 +++
1884 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1885 filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
1886 fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
1887
1888 +++
1889 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1890 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1891 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1892
1893 +++
1894 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
1895 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
1896 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
1897 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
1898 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
1899 from the file name or buffer contents.
1900
1901 +++
1902 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
1903
1904 ---
1905 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
1906
1907 ---
1908 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
1909
1910 +++
1911 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
1912 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
1913 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
1914
1915 ---
1916 ** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
1917 `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
1918
1919 ** F90 mode now has support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
1920 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
1921 majority.
1922
1923 ---
1924 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
1925 to support use of font-lock.
1926
1927 +++
1928 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
1929 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
1930 `same-window'.
1931
1932 +++
1933 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
1934 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
1935 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
1936
1937 +++
1938 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
1939 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
1940 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
1941 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
1942 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
1943 candidate is a directory.
1944
1945 +++
1946 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
1947 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1948 it remains unchanged.
1949
1950 ** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
1951
1952 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
1953 have in common and where they begin to differ.
1954
1955 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
1956 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
1957 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
1958 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
1959 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
1960 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
1961 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
1962 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
1963
1964 +++
1965 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
1966 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
1967 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
1968
1969 ---
1970 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
1971
1972 ---
1973 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
1974 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
1975 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
1976
1977 ---
1978 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
1979 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
1980
1981 ---
1982 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
1983 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
1984 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
1985 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
1986 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
1987 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
1988 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
1989
1990 ---
1991 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
1992 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
1993 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
1994 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
1995 sound support for those formats.
1996
1997 ---
1998 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
1999 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2000
2001 ---
2002 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2003 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2004 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2005 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2006
2007 ---
2008 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2009 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2010 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2011 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2012 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2013 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2014 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2015 you wish to use them in other faces.
2016
2017 +++
2018 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2019 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2020 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2021 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2022 Meta and Alt:
2023 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2024 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
2025
2026 +++
2027 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2028
2029 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2030 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2031 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2032
2033 P: annotates the previous revision
2034 N: annotates the next revision
2035 J: annotates the revision at line
2036 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2037 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2038 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2039 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2040
2041 +++
2042 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2043 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2044 in the repository.
2045
2046 +++
2047 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2048 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2049 "checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2050 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2051
2052 \f
2053 * New modes and packages in Emacs 21.4
2054
2055 ** The new package password.el provide a password cache and expiring mechanism.
2056
2057 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2058 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2059 to increment the SOA serial.
2060
2061 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2062 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2063
2064 ** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2065 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2066 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2067
2068 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
2069 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2070
2071 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2072 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2073
2074 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2075
2076 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2077
2078 +++
2079 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2080 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2081
2082 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
2083
2084 ---
2085 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2086
2087 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2088 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2089 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2090 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
2091
2092 ---
2093 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2094
2095 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2096 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2097 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2098 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2099 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2100 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2101
2102 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2103 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2104 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2105 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2106
2107 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2108 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2109 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2110 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2111 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2112 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2113 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2114
2115 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2116 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2117 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2118
2119 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2120 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2121
2122 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2123 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2124 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2125 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2126
2127 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2128 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2129 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2130 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2131
2132 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2133 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2134 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2135 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2136
2137 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
2138 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2139 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2140 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2141 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2142
2143 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2144 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2145 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2146 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2147 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2148 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2149
2150 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2151 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2152 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2153 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2154 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2155 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2156 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
2157 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2158 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2159 or local keymaps.
2160
2161 +++
2162 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
2163 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2164
2165 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2166 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2167 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
2168 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2169
2170 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2171 defined macros.
2172
2173 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2174 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2175 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2176 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2177 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2178 for more commands.
2179
2180 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
2181 the keyboard macro ring.
2182
2183 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2184 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
2185
2186 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2187 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2188 this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2189 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2190
2191 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
2192 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
2193 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2194
2195 ---
2196 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2197 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2198 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2199 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2200
2201 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2202
2203 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2204 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2205 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2206 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2207 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2208 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2209
2210 +++
2211 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2212
2213 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2214 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
2215 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2216 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
2217
2218 +++
2219 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
2220
2221 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2222 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2223 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2224 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2225 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2226 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2227 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2228 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2229 `rsync' to do the copying).
2230
2231 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2232 `su' and `sudo'.
2233
2234 ---
2235 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
2236 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2237 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2238 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2239 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2240 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
2241
2242 ---
2243 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
2244 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2245 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2246 settings.
2247
2248 ---
2249 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
2250 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
2251 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2252 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2253
2254 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
2255
2256 ---
2257 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
2258 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2259
2260 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
2261 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2262 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2263 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2264 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2265 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2266
2267 +++
2268 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2269 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2270 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2271 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2272
2273 ---
2274 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2275 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2276 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2277 mode-lines in inverse-video.
2278
2279 ---
2280 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2281
2282 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2283 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2284
2285 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
2286
2287 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2288 configuration files.
2289 \f
2290 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
2291
2292 +++
2293 ** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2294 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2295 previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2296
2297 ** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2298 argument.
2299
2300 +++
2301 ** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
2302 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
2303
2304 +++
2305 ** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2306 `buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2307
2308 +++
2309 ** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
2310 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
2311 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2312
2313 ** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2314 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2315 the usable window height and width is used.
2316
2317 +++
2318 ** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2319 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2320
2321 ** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
2322 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2323 During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2324 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2325 it changes to nil.
2326
2327 +++
2328 ** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2329
2330 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2331 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2332 example,
2333
2334 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2335
2336 ** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2337 delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2338 deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2339 sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2340 changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2341
2342 ** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
2343 undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
2344 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
2345
2346 ---
2347 ** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2348 current input method to input a character.
2349
2350 +++
2351 ** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
2352 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2353 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
2354
2355 ** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2356 character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2357 and ranges.
2358
2359 ** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
2360 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
2361 arg is non-nil.
2362
2363 ** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
2364
2365 +++
2366 ** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2367 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2368 operation.
2369
2370 ** file-remote-p now returns an identifier for the remote system,
2371 if the file is indeed remote. (Before, the return value was t in
2372 this case.)
2373
2374 +++
2375 ** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
2376 supported on text terminals.
2377
2378 +++
2379 ** Support for displaying image slices
2380
2381 *** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
2382 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
2383
2384 *** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
2385 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
2386
2387 *** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
2388 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
2389
2390 +++
2391 ** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
2392
2393 A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
2394 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
2395
2396 If the line-height property value is 0, the newline does not
2397 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
2398 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
2399 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
2400 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
2401
2402 If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2403 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2404 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
2405
2406 If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
2407 is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
2408 given value.
2409
2410 If the line-height property value is a cons (RATIO . FACE), the
2411 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
2412 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
2413
2414 If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
2415 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
2416 overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
2417 the line-spacing variable.
2418
2419 If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
2420 is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
2421
2422 If the line-spacing value is a cons (total . SPACING) where SPACING is
2423 any of the forms described above, the value of SPACING is used as the
2424 total height of the line, i.e. a varying number of pixels are inserted
2425 after each line to make each line exactly that many pixels high.
2426
2427 ** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
2428 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
2429
2430 +++
2431 ** Enhancements to stretch display properties
2432
2433 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
2434 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
2435 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
2436
2437 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
2438 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
2439 are supported:
2440
2441 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
2442 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
2443 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
2444 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
2445 | scroll-bar | text
2446 POS ::= left | center | right
2447 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
2448 OP ::= + | -
2449
2450 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
2451 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
2452 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
2453 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
2454 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
2455 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
2456 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
2457 the image.
2458
2459 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
2460 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
2461 corresponding area of the window.
2462
2463 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
2464 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
2465 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
2466 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
2467 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
2468 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
2469 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
2470 the width of the area.
2471
2472 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
2473 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
2474
2475 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
2476 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
2477 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
2478
2479 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
2480 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
2481 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
2482 height) of the specified image.
2483
2484 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
2485 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
2486
2487 +++
2488 ** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
2489 text property string that may be present at the current window
2490 position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
2491 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
2492
2493 ** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2494 around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2495 and post-command-hooks.
2496
2497 +++
2498 ** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
2499 to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
2500 foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
2501 a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
2502 preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
2503 use of the capabilities of the display.
2504
2505 +++
2506 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
2507
2508 *** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
2509 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
2510
2511 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
2512 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
2513
2514 *** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
2515 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
2516
2517 *** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
2518 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
2519 this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
2520 the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
2521
2522 *** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
2523 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
2524 bitmap of the display line.
2525
2526 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
2527 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
2528 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
2529 for displaying the bitmap.
2530
2531 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
2532 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
2533
2534 ** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
2535 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
2536 varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
2537 the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
2538
2539 Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
2540 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
2541 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
2542 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
2543 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
2544 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
2545
2546 +++
2547 ** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
2548 line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
2549 number of corresponding line in current buffer.
2550
2551 +++
2552 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
2553 variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
2554 that end a sentence without following spaces.
2555
2556 +++
2557 ** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
2558 the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
2559 then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
2560 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
2561 `sentence-end-without-space'.
2562
2563 +++
2564 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
2565 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
2566 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
2567
2568 ** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
2569 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
2570 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
2571 if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
2572
2573 +++
2574 ** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
2575 from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
2576 the first one is kept.
2577
2578 +++
2579 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
2580 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
2581
2582 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
2583 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
2584 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
2585 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
2586
2587 +++
2588 ** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
2589 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
2590 string. The old behavior is available if you call
2591 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
2592
2593 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
2594 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
2595 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
2596 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
2597 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
2598
2599 +++ (lispref)
2600 ??? (man)
2601 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
2602 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
2603 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
2604 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
2605 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
2606
2607 +++
2608 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
2609 :pointer image property.
2610
2611 +++
2612 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
2613 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
2614
2615 +++
2616 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
2617
2618 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
2619 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
2620 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
2621 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
2622 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
2623 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
2624 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
2625 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
2626
2627 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
2628 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
2629 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
2630 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
2631 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
2632 for possible pointer shapes.
2633
2634 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
2635 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
2636 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
2637
2638 ** Mouse event enhancements:
2639
2640 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
2641 events, rather than a text area click event.
2642
2643 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
2644 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
2645 corresponding text row.
2646
2647 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
2648
2649 +++
2650 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
2651
2652 +++
2653 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
2654
2655 +++
2656 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
2657 text area).
2658
2659 +++
2660 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
2661
2662 +++
2663 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
2664
2665 +++
2666 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
2667
2668 +++
2669 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
2670 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
2671
2672 +++
2673 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
2674 (image or character) clicked on.
2675
2676 +++
2677 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
2678 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
2679 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
2680 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
2681
2682 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
2683 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
2684 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
2685 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
2686 forcing an explicit window update.
2687
2688 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
2689 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
2690
2691 +++
2692 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
2693 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
2694 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
2695 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
2696 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
2697
2698 +++
2699 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
2700
2701 +++
2702 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
2703 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
2704 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
2705 documented.
2706
2707 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
2708 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
2709 the language.
2710
2711 ---
2712 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
2713 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
2714 parts, e.g. utf-16.
2715
2716 +++
2717 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
2718 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2719
2720 +++
2721 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
2722 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
2723 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
2724
2725 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
2726 does that, this value may not be accurate.
2727
2728 +++
2729 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
2730 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
2731 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
2732 the mode line.
2733
2734 +++
2735 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
2736 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
2737
2738 +++
2739 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2740
2741 +++
2742 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
2743 `switch-to-buffer'.
2744
2745 +++
2746 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
2747 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
2748
2749 +++
2750 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
2751 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
2752 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
2753
2754 +++
2755 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
2756 in the keymap.
2757
2758 ---
2759 ** VC changes for backends:
2760 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
2761 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
2762 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
2763 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
2764 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
2765
2766 +++
2767 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
2768 as a dynamic completion table.
2769
2770 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
2771
2772 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
2773 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
2774 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
2775 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
2776 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
2777 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
2778
2779 +++
2780 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
2781 as a lazy completion table.
2782
2783 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
2784
2785 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
2786 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
2787 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
2788 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
2789 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
2790 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
2791
2792 +++
2793 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
2794
2795 +++
2796 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
2797 for all (existing and future) frames.
2798
2799 +++
2800 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
2801
2802 +++
2803 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
2804
2805 +++
2806 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
2807
2808 +++
2809 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
2810 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
2811 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
2812 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
2813 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
2814
2815 +++
2816 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
2817 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
2818 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
2819 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
2820
2821 +++
2822 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
2823 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
2824 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
2825 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
2826
2827 ---
2828 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
2829 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
2830
2831 +++
2832 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
2833 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
2834 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
2835 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
2836
2837 +++
2838 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
2839 of a string given to a process's filter.
2840
2841 +++
2842 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
2843 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
2844
2845 +++
2846 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
2847 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
2848 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
2849 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
2850
2851 +++
2852 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
2853 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
2854 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
2855 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
2856 which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
2857
2858 +++
2859 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
2860 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
2861
2862 +++
2863 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
2864 on garbage collection.
2865
2866 +++
2867 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
2868 it is read from a file without decoding.
2869
2870 +++
2871 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
2872
2873 +++
2874 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
2875 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
2876 by calling `select-window'.
2877
2878 ---
2879 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
2880 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
2881 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
2882 need to have a name.
2883
2884 ** Byte compiler changes:
2885
2886 ---
2887 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
2888 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
2889 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
2890 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
2891 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
2892 you anything.
2893
2894 +++
2895 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
2896 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
2897 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
2898 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
2899 forms:
2900
2901 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
2902 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
2903
2904 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
2905 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
2906 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
2907 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
2908 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
2909 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
2910
2911 +++
2912 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
2913 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
2914
2915 +++
2916 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
2917 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
2918 be inserted is translated through it.
2919
2920 +++
2921 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
2922 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
2923 current file redefined it).
2924
2925 +++
2926 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
2927 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
2928 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
2929 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
2930 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
2931 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
2932
2933 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
2934 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
2935 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
2936 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
2937 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
2938
2939 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
2940 out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
2941 It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
2942 suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
2943 during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
2944 returns differing values.
2945
2946 +++
2947 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
2948 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
2949 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
2950
2951 +++
2952 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
2953 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
2954 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
2955 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
2956
2957 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
2958 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
2959
2960 +++
2961 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
2962 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
2963
2964 +++
2965 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
2966 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
2967
2968 +++
2969 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
2970 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
2971 can start with this line:
2972
2973 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
2974
2975 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
2976 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
2977 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
2978
2979 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
2980
2981 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
2982 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
2983
2984 +++
2985 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
2986 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
2987
2988 ---
2989 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
2990 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
2991
2992 +++
2993 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
2994 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
2995 the current buffer.
2996
2997 +++
2998 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
2999 and `display-warning'.
3000
3001 +++
3002 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3003 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3004 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3005 exported to Lisp.
3006
3007 ---
3008 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3009 much pure storage it will approximately need.
3010
3011 +++
3012 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3013 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3014 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3015 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3016
3017 ---
3018 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3019 of one coding system from another coding system.
3020
3021 +++
3022 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3023 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3024 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3025 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3026 needed.
3027
3028 ---
3029 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3030 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3031 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3032 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3033 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3034 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3035
3036 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3037 confirmation as before.
3038
3039 +++
3040 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
3041
3042 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3043 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3044 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3045 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
3046
3047 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3048 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3049 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3050 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3051 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3052 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
3053
3054 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3055 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3056 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3057 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3058
3059 +++
3060 ** Per-window fringes settings
3061
3062 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3063 settings.
3064
3065 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3066 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3067 `set-window-fringes'.
3068
3069 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3070 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3071 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3072 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3073
3074 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3075 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3076 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3077 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3078 an update of the display margins.
3079
3080 +++
3081 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3082
3083 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3084 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3085
3086 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3087 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3088 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3089 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3090 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3091 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3092 of the display margins.
3093
3094 +++
3095 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3096 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3097 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3098
3099 +++
3100 ** Renamed file hooks to follow the convention:
3101 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3102 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3103 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
3104 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions.
3105 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3106
3107 +++
3108 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
3109 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3110 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3111
3112 +++
3113 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3114 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3115 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3116 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3117 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3118
3119 ---
3120 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3121 to override the internal read-file-name function.
3122
3123
3124 ** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3125 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3126 `read-file-name' function.
3127
3128 +++
3129 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3130 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3131 will only show directories.
3132
3133 +++
3134 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3135 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3136 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3137
3138 ---
3139 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3140 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3141 (require 'cl) when loaded.
3142
3143 +++
3144 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3145 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3146 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3147
3148 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3149
3150 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3151 declaration specifiers supported are:
3152
3153 (indent INDENT)
3154 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3155
3156 (edebug DEBUG)
3157 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3158 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3159
3160 +++
3161 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3162
3163 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
3164 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3165 binding and lookup functionality.
3166
3167 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3168 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3169 original command.
3170
3171 Example:
3172 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3173 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3174 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3175 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3176 kill-word.
3177
3178 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3179 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3180 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3181 map using define-key:
3182
3183 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3184 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3185
3186 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3187 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3188
3189 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3190 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3191 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3192
3193 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3194
3195 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3196 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3197 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3198 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3199
3200 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3201 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3202
3203 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3204 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3205
3206 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3207 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3208 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3209 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3210 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3211 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3212
3213 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3214 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3215 command was not remapped.
3216
3217 +++
3218 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3219
3220 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3221 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3222 alist to this list.
3223
3224 +++
3225 ** Atomic change groups.
3226
3227 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3228 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3229 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3230
3231 (atomic-change-group
3232 (insert foo)
3233 (delete-region x y))
3234
3235 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3236 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3237 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3238 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3239
3240 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3241 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3242
3243 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3244 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3245 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3246 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3247
3248 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3249 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3250 do this.
3251
3252 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3253 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3254 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3255 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3256
3257 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3258 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3259 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3260 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3261 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3262 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3263 twice.
3264
3265 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3266 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3267 returned values, like this:
3268
3269 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3270 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3271
3272 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3273 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3274 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3275
3276 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3277 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3278 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3279 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3280 finished.
3281
3282 +++
3283 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3284
3285 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3286 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3287 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3288 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3289
3290 +++
3291 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3292
3293 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3294 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3295 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3296 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3297
3298 +++
3299 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3300
3301 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3302 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3303 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3304
3305 +++
3306 ** New function insert-for-yank.
3307
3308 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3309 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3310 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3311 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3312 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3313
3314 +++
3315 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3316
3317 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3318 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3319
3320 +++
3321 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3322
3323 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3324 text properties from the inserted substring.
3325
3326 +++
3327 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3328 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3329
3330 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3331 elements with the following format:
3332 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3333
3334 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3335 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3336 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3337 the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3338
3339 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3340 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3341 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3342 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3343 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3344 rectangle.
3345 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3346 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3347 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3348 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3349 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3350 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3351 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3352 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3353
3354 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3355 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3356 the killed text.
3357
3358 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3359 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3360 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3361 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3362 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3363
3364 +++
3365 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3366 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3367
3368 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3369 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3370 defined with defface.
3371
3372 ** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3373 given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3374 it did only a very cursory check).
3375
3376 +++
3377 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3378 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3379 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3380
3381 +++
3382 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3383 help with handling relative face attributes.
3384
3385 ** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3386 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3387 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3388 of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3389 :inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3390 properties.
3391
3392 +++
3393 ** Enhancements to process support
3394
3395 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3396 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3397
3398 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3399 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3400 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3401
3402 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3403 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3404
3405 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3406 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3407
3408 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3409 and modify elements on this property list.
3410
3411 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3412 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3413
3414 *** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3415 `just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3416 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3417 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3418 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3419 speech synthesis.
3420
3421 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3422
3423 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3424 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3425 very poor performance. This behaviour can be remedied to some extent
3426 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3427 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3428 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3429 emacs tries to read it.
3430
3431 +++
3432 ** Enhanced networking support.
3433
3434 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3435 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3436 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3437
3438 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3439 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3440 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3441 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3442 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3443 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3444 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3445 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3446
3447 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3448 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3449
3450 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3451
3452 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3453
3454 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3455 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3456 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3457 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3458 matching "open" or "failed".
3459
3460 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
3461
3462 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3463 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3464 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3465 is called for the new process.
3466
3467 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
3468
3469 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3470 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3471
3472 *** New function format-network-address.
3473
3474 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3475 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3476 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3477 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3478 string for other formatting options.
3479
3480 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3481 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3482 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3483
3484 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3485 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3486 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3487 the fifth is the port number.
3488
3489 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3490 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3491 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3492 no input is received in the stopped state.
3493
3494 *** New function network-interface-list.
3495
3496 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3497 current network addresses.
3498
3499 *** New function network-interface-info.
3500
3501 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3502 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3503
3504 +++
3505 ** New function copy-tree.
3506
3507 +++
3508 ** New function substring-no-properties.
3509
3510 +++
3511 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
3512
3513 +++
3514 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
3515
3516 ** New function `process-file'.
3517
3518 This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
3519 handler is chosen based on default-directory.
3520
3521 ---
3522 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
3523 are now always lower case. If you specify the
3524 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
3525 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
3526
3527 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
3528 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
3529
3530 +++
3531 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
3532 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
3533 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
3534 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
3535
3536 ---
3537 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
3538 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
3539
3540 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
3541 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
3542 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
3543 commands.
3544
3545 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
3546 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
3547 SQL buffer.
3548
3549 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
3550 (function (lambda ()
3551 (master-mode t)
3552 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3553 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
3554 (function (lambda ()
3555 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3556
3557 +++
3558 ** File local variables.
3559
3560 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3561 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3562
3563 +++
3564 ** New function window-body-height.
3565
3566 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3567 or the header line.
3568
3569 +++
3570 ** New function format-mode-line.
3571
3572 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
3573 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
3574
3575 +++
3576 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3577
3578 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
3579 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3580
3581 +++
3582 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
3583
3584 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
3585 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
3586 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
3587 you specify the map to use as an argument.
3588
3589 +++
3590 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3591
3592 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3593 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3594 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3595
3596 +++
3597 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3598
3599 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3600 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3601 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3602 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3603 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3604
3605 +++
3606 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
3607 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
3608 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
3609 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
3610
3611 +++
3612 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
3613 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
3614
3615 +++
3616 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3617 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3618 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3619
3620 +++
3621 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
3622 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
3623 line.
3624
3625 ---
3626 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
3627 cl-indent package. The new user options
3628 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
3629 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
3630 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
3631
3632 ---
3633 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
3634 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3635
3636 +++
3637 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
3638
3639 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
3640 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
3641 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
3642 now:
3643
3644 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
3645
3646 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
3647 the time it takes to convert the format.
3648
3649 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
3650 wasteful.
3651
3652 +++
3653 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3654 over minor mode keymaps.
3655
3656 +++
3657 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3658 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3659
3660 +++
3661 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
3662 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
3663 image or composition property.
3664
3665 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
3666 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
3667 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
3668 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
3669 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
3670
3671 +++
3672 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
3673 argument, LIMIT.
3674
3675 +++
3676 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3677 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3678 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3679 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3680 flag.
3681
3682 ---
3683 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3684
3685 ---
3686 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
3687
3688 ---
3689 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3690 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3691 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3692 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3693 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3694 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3695
3696 ---
3697 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3698 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3699 bindings of the parent keymap.
3700
3701 ---
3702 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3703 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3704 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3705 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3706 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3707 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3708
3709 s{
3710 foo
3711 }{
3712 bar
3713 }e
3714
3715 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3716 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3717 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3718 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3719
3720 ---
3721 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
3722 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
3723
3724 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
3725 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
3726
3727 +++
3728 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
3729 it receives a request from emacsclient.
3730
3731 ---
3732 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
3733 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
3734 than 3 levels of nesting.
3735
3736 ---
3737 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
3738 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
3739 it in that buffer.
3740
3741 ---
3742 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3743 properties from surrounding text.
3744
3745 +++
3746 ** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3747 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3748 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3749
3750 +++
3751 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
3752
3753 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
3754 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
3755 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
3756
3757 ---
3758 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3759 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3760 clone to the other.
3761
3762 +++
3763 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
3764 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
3765 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
3766 other properties than `face'.
3767 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
3768 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
3769
3770 ---
3771 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
3772 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
3773 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
3774 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
3775 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
3776
3777 +++
3778 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
3779 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
3780 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
3781
3782 +++
3783 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
3784 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
3785
3786 +++
3787 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
3788 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
3789
3790 +++
3791 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
3792 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
3793 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
3794
3795 +++
3796 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3797 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3798 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3799
3800 +++
3801 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
3802 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
3803 accepts a float as UID parameter.
3804
3805 ---
3806 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3807
3808 +++
3809 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
3810
3811 +++
3812 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
3813 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
3814 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
3815 the output of other GNU tools.
3816
3817 +++
3818 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
3819
3820 ---
3821 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
3822
3823 +++
3824 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3825 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
3826
3827 +++
3828 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
3829
3830 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3831
3832 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3833 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3834 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3835 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3836
3837 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3838 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3839
3840 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
3841
3842 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3843 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3844 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3845
3846 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3847 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3848
3849 +++
3850 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3851 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3852
3853 +++
3854 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
3855 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
3856
3857 +++
3858 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
3859 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3860
3861 ---
3862 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
3863 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
3864 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
3865
3866 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
3867 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3868 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3869
3870 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
3871 running under X.
3872
3873 ** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
3874 all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
3875
3876 ** New packages:
3877
3878 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
3879 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
3880 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
3881 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
3882 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
3883 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
3884
3885 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
3886
3887 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
3888 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
3889
3890 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
3891 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
3892 data structures.
3893
3894 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
3895 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
3896
3897 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
3898 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
3899 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
3900 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
3901 as help and apropos buffers.
3902
3903 \f
3904 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
3905
3906 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
3907 been added.
3908
3909 \f
3910 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
3911
3912 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
3913 with Custom.
3914
3915 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
3916 as mule-utf-8.
3917
3918 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
3919 in UTF-8 locales).
3920
3921 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
3922 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
3923 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
3924 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
3925 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
3926 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
3927 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
3928 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
3929 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
3930 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
3931
3932 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
3933 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
3934
3935 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
3936 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
3937 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
3938 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
3939 contrary to the compound text specification.
3940
3941 \f
3942 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
3943
3944 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
3945
3946 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
3947
3948 \f
3949 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
3950
3951 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
3952
3953 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
3954 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
3955 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
3956 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
3957 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
3958
3959 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
3960 were changed.
3961
3962 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
3963 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
3964
3965 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
3966 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
3967 instead of using default-major-mode.
3968
3969 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
3970 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
3971 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
3972 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
3973 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
3974 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
3975 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
3976
3977 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
3978 NEWS.
3979
3980 \f
3981 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
3982
3983 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
3984 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
3985 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
3986
3987 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
3988 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
3989
3990 \f
3991 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
3992
3993 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
3994 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
3995 charsets in this release.
3996
3997 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
3998
3999 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4000
4001 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
4002 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4003 to list them.
4004
4005 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
4006 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
4007 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4008 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4009 necessary changes to unexec.
4010
4011 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4012 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4013
4014 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4015 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4016
4017 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4018 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
4019
4020 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
4021 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
4022 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4023 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4024 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
4025
4026 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4027 new display features described below.
4028
4029 \f
4030 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
4031
4032 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4033
4034 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4035 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4036 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4037 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4038 the text.
4039
4040 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4041
4042 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4043 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4044 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4045 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4046 specify a font.
4047
4048 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4049 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4050 under Lisp changes, below.
4051
4052 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4053
4054 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4055 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4056 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4057 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4058 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4059 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4060 on terminals.
4061
4062 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4063 supported on character terminals.
4064
4065 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4066 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4067 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4068 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4069
4070 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4071
4072 ** Sound support
4073
4074 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4075 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4076 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
4077 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4078 sound support.
4079
4080 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4081
4082 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4083 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4084 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4085 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4086
4087 - User option: max-mini-window-height
4088
4089 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4090 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4091 specifies a number of lines.
4092
4093 Default is 0.25.
4094
4095 - User option: resize-mini-windows
4096
4097 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4098 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4099 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4100 again.
4101
4102 Default is `grow-only'.
4103
4104 ** LessTif support.
4105
4106 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
4107 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
4108
4109 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4110
4111 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4112 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4113 non-nil.
4114
4115 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4116
4117 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4118 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4119 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4120
4121 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
4122
4123 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4124 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4125 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4126 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4127 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4128 Emacs.
4129
4130 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4131 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4132 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4133 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4134 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4135 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4136
4137 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4138 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4139 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4140 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4141 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4142 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4143
4144 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4145 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4146 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
4147 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
4148 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4149
4150 ** Tool bar support.
4151
4152 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4153 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4154 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4155 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4156 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4157 icons will be used.
4158
4159 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
4160 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
4161
4162 ** Tooltips.
4163
4164 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4165 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4166 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4167
4168 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4169 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4170 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4171 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4172
4173 ** Automatic Hscrolling
4174
4175 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4176 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4177 customized.
4178
4179 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4180 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4181 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4182 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4183 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4184
4185 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4186 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4187 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
4188 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
4189 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
4190 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
4191
4192 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4193 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4194 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4195 customizing face `fringe'.
4196
4197 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4198 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4199 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4200 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4201 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4202 the window to be partially obscured.)
4203
4204 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
4205 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4206 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4207 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
4208
4209 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4210
4211 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4212 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4213 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4214 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4215 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4216 have enabled one.
4217
4218 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4219
4220 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
4221
4222 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
4223
4224 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4225 `*') toggles the status.
4226
4227 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4228
4229 ** Hourglass pointer
4230
4231 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4232 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4233
4234 ** Blinking cursor
4235
4236 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4237 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4238 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4239 the group `cursor'.
4240
4241 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4242
4243 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4244 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4245 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4246 details.
4247
4248 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4249 have to do anything to activate it.
4250
4251 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4252
4253 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4254 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4255
4256 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4257 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4258 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4259 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4260 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4261 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4262 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4263 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4264
4265 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4266 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4267 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4268 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4269 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4270 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4271
4272 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4273 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4274
4275 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4276 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4277 buffer by default.
4278
4279 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4280 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4281 beginning and end of the buffer.
4282
4283 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4284 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4285 signaled.
4286
4287 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4288 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4289
4290 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4291 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4292 this behavior.
4293
4294 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
4295 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4296 Emacs dump core.
4297
4298 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4299
4300 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4301 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4302 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4303
4304 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4305 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4306 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4307
4308 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4309 using that menu.
4310
4311 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4312
4313 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4314 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4315 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4316 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4317 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4318 whitespace.
4319
4320 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4321 all frames except the selected one.
4322
4323 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4324 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4325
4326 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4327 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4328 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4329 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
4330 `Info-use-header-line'.
4331
4332 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
4333 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
4334 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
4335
4336 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
4337
4338 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
4339 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
4340 `fr-drdref.tex'.
4341
4342 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
4343 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
4344 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
4345 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
4346
4347 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
4348
4349 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
4350 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
4351 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
4352 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
4353
4354 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
4355 point in a pop-up window.
4356
4357 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
4358 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
4359 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
4360
4361 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
4362 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
4363
4364 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
4365 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
4366 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
4367 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
4368
4369 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
4370
4371 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
4372 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
4373
4374 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
4375 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
4376 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
4377
4378 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
4379 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
4380 non-nil.
4381
4382 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
4383 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
4384 file that is already visited under a different name.
4385
4386 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
4387 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
4388
4389 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
4390 and displays information about that.
4391
4392 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
4393 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
4394
4395 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
4396 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
4397 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
4398 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
4399 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
4400 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
4401
4402 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
4403 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
4404
4405 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
4406 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
4407 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
4408 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
4409 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
4410 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
4411 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
4412
4413 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
4414 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
4415
4416 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
4417 system for keyboard input.
4418
4419 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
4420 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
4421 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
4422 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
4423 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
4424 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
4425 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
4426 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
4427 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
4428
4429 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
4430 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
4431
4432 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
4433 displays all characters in that character set.
4434
4435 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
4436 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
4437
4438 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
4439 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
4440 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
4441
4442 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
4443 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
4444 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
4445 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
4446 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
4447 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
4448 and Polish `slash'.
4449
4450 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
4451 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
4452 of the tutorial.
4453
4454 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
4455 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
4456 Lisp Coding Convention".
4457
4458 new command old-binding
4459 --- ------- -----------
4460 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
4461 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
4462 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
4463
4464 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
4465 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
4466 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
4467
4468 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
4469 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
4470 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
4471 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
4472 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
4473 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
4474
4475 ** There are new Leim input methods.
4476 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
4477 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
4478 package.
4479
4480 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
4481 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
4482 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
4483 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
4484 "`", you must type "=q".
4485
4486 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
4487 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
4488 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
4489 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
4490 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
4491 on.
4492
4493 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
4494 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
4495 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
4496 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
4497
4498 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
4499 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
4500 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
4501 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
4502
4503 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
4504 on the display using several methods
4505
4506 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
4507 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
4508 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
4509
4510 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
4511 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
4512
4513 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
4514
4515 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
4516 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
4517
4518 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
4519 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
4520 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
4521 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
4522
4523 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
4524 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
4525 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
4526
4527 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
4528 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
4529
4530 ** New X resources recognized
4531
4532 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
4533 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
4534 is useful for debugging X problems.
4535
4536 Example:
4537
4538 emacs.synchronous: true
4539
4540 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
4541 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
4542 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
4543 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
4544 visual class names are
4545
4546 TrueColor
4547 PseudoColor
4548 DirectColor
4549 StaticColor
4550 GrayScale
4551 StaticGray
4552
4553 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
4554 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
4555 meaning.
4556
4557 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
4558 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
4559 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
4560 visual.
4561
4562 Example:
4563
4564 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
4565
4566 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
4567 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
4568 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
4569 resource values are `true' or `on'.
4570
4571 Example:
4572
4573 emacs.privateColormap: true
4574
4575 ** Faces and frame parameters.
4576
4577 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
4578 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
4579 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
4580 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
4581 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
4582 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
4583 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
4584
4585 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
4586 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
4587 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
4588 `default' face and vice versa.
4589
4590 ** New face `menu'.
4591
4592 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
4593
4594 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
4595
4596 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
4597 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
4598 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
4599 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
4600
4601 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
4602 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
4603 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
4604
4605 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
4606 `ScreenGamma'.
4607
4608 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
4609
4610 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
4611 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
4612 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
4613 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
4614
4615 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
4616
4617 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
4618
4619 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
4620
4621 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
4622 LessTif/Motif one.
4623
4624 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
4625 LessTif and Motif.
4626
4627 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
4628
4629 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
4630 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
4631 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
4632
4633 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
4634 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
4635
4636 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
4637 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
4638 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
4639
4640 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
4641
4642 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
4643 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
4644 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
4645 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
4646
4647 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
4648 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
4649 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
4650 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
4651
4652 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
4653 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
4654 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
4655 buffers.
4656
4657 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
4658
4659 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
4660 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
4661 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
4662
4663 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
4664 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
4665 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
4666 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
4667 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
4668 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
4669
4670 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
4671
4672 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
4673 notably at the end of lines.
4674
4675 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
4676 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
4677
4678 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
4679
4680 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
4681 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
4682
4683 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
4684 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
4685 after each match to get the replacement text.
4686
4687 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
4688 you edit the replacement string.
4689
4690 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
4691 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
4692 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4693
4694 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
4695
4696 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
4697 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
4698
4699 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
4700 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
4701 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
4702 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
4703
4704 --
4705 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
4706 read mail from the menu etc.
4707
4708 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
4709 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
4710 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
4711 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
4712
4713 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
4714 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
4715
4716 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
4717 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
4718 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
4719 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
4720 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
4721 of Emacs.
4722
4723 ** Customize changes
4724
4725 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
4726 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
4727 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
4728 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
4729 earlier versions of Emacs.
4730
4731 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
4732 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
4733 default).
4734
4735 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4736 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
4737 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
4738 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
4739 file.
4740
4741 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4742 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
4743 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
4744 already in your init file.
4745
4746 ** New features in evaluation commands
4747
4748 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
4749 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
4750 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
4751 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
4752 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
4753
4754 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
4755 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
4756 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
4757 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
4758 printed).
4759
4760 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
4761 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
4762
4763 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
4764 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
4765
4766 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
4767 code when called with a prefix argument.
4768
4769 ** CC mode changes.
4770
4771 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
4772 current user setups (although it's believed that these
4773 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
4774 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
4775 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
4776 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
4777 release.
4778
4779 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
4780 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
4781 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
4782 confusion.
4783
4784 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
4785 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
4786 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
4787 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
4788
4789 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
4790 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
4791
4792 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
4793 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
4794
4795 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
4796 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
4797 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
4798 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
4799
4800 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
4801 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
4802 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
4803 earlier statement. An example:
4804
4805 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
4806 if (a[i])
4807 res += a[i]->offset;
4808 else
4809
4810 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
4811 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
4812 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
4813 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
4814 the preceding "if".
4815
4816 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
4817 by default.
4818
4819 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
4820 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
4821 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
4822 documentation or other natural language text.
4823
4824 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
4825 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
4826 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
4827 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
4828 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
4829 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
4830 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
4831
4832 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
4833 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
4834 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
4835 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
4836
4837 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
4838 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
4839 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
4840 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
4841 Pike mode only.
4842
4843 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
4844 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
4845 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
4846 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
4847 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
4848 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
4849 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
4850 is reported afterwards.
4851
4852 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
4853 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
4854 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
4855
4856 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
4857 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
4858 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
4859 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
4860 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
4861 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
4862 groundwork.
4863
4864 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
4865 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
4866 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
4867 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
4868 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
4869 have to bother.
4870
4871 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
4872 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
4873 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
4874 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
4875 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
4876 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
4877
4878 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
4879 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
4880 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
4881 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
4882 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
4883 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
4884 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
4885 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
4886
4887 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
4888 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
4889 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
4890 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
4891 above.
4892
4893 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
4894 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
4895 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
4896 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
4897 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
4898 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
4899 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
4900 function documentation for more info.
4901
4902 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
4903 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
4904 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
4905 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
4906 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
4907 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
4908 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
4909 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
4910
4911 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
4912
4913 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
4914 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
4915
4916 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
4917 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
4918 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
4919 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
4920 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
4921 style system.
4922
4923 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
4924 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
4925 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
4926 as far as possible.
4927
4928 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
4929 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
4930 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
4931 chapter about this in the manual.
4932
4933 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
4934 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
4935 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
4936 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
4937 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
4938
4939 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
4940 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
4941 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
4942
4943 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
4944 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
4945
4946 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
4947 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
4948 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
4949 inside CC Mode.
4950
4951 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
4952 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
4953 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
4954 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
4955 cc-mode/).
4956
4957 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
4958 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
4959 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
4960 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
4961 they were before the filling.
4962
4963 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
4964 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
4965 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
4966 literals.
4967
4968 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
4969 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
4970 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
4971 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
4972 this function.
4973
4974 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
4975 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
4976 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
4977 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
4978 Thanks to Eric Eide.
4979
4980 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
4981 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
4982 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
4983
4984 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
4985
4986 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
4987 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
4988 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
4989 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
4990
4991 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
4992 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
4993 the column specified by comment-column.
4994
4995 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
4996 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
4997 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
4998 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
4999 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5000 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5001
5002 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5003 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5004 arguments.
5005
5006 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5007
5008 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5009 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5010 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5011 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5012 Provan).
5013
5014 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5015
5016 ** Dired changes
5017
5018 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5019 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5020 is, delete only empty directories.
5021
5022 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5023 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5024 copy directories recursively.
5025
5026 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5027 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5028 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
5029
5030 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5031 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5032 directory.
5033
5034 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
5035 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5036 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5037 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5038 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5039
5040 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5041 from ls switches.
5042
5043 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5044 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5045 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5046 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
5047
5048 ** Gnus changes.
5049
5050 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5051 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5052 internationalization and mail-fetching.
5053
5054 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5055 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
5056
5057 If you used procmail like in
5058
5059 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5060 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5061 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5062 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
5063
5064 this now has changed to
5065
5066 (setq mail-sources
5067 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5068 :suffix ".in")))
5069
5070 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5071 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
5072
5073 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5074 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5075 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5076 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
5077
5078 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5079 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5080 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
5081
5082 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5083 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5084 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5085 now just a compatibility layer.
5086
5087 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5088 Gnus facilities.
5089
5090 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5091 called to position point.
5092
5093 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5094 summary buffers and NOV files.
5095
5096 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5097 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
5098
5099 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5100 subtly different manner.
5101
5102 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5103 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5104 ever-changing layouts.
5105
5106 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
5107
5108 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
5109
5110 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
5111
5112 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5113 macros
5114
5115 Key binding Macro
5116 -------------------------
5117 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5118 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5119 C-c C-c u @uref
5120 C-c C-c q @quotation
5121 C-c C-c m @email
5122 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5123 M-RET @item
5124
5125 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
5126
5127 ** Changes in Outline mode.
5128
5129 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5130 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5131 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
5132
5133 ** Changes to Emacs Server
5134
5135 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5136 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5137 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5138 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5139 buffers to kill, as before.
5140
5141 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5142 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5143 this way.
5144
5145 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5146 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5147
5148 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5149
5150 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5151 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5152 use. Default is 1000.
5153
5154 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5155 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
5156
5157 ** Changes to hideshow.el
5158
5159 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
5160
5161 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5162 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5163 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5164 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
5165
5166 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5167 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5168 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5169 the open block.
5170
5171 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5172 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5173 the normal block-hiding function.
5174
5175 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
5176
5177 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5178 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5179 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5180 for `hs-minor-mode'.
5181
5182 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5183 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
5184
5185 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
5186
5187 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5188 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5189 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
5190
5191 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5192 current buffer.
5193
5194 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5195 in a log file.
5196
5197 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5198 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5199 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5200 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5201 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5202 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5203
5204 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5205
5206 ** Changes to cmuscheme
5207
5208 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5209 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5210
5211 ** Changes in Font Lock
5212
5213 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5214 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5215
5216 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5217 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5218
5219 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5220 the face used for each string/comment.
5221
5222 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5223 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5224
5225 ** Changes to Shell mode
5226
5227 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5228 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5229 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5230 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5231
5232 ** Comint (subshell) changes
5233
5234 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5235 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5236
5237 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5238 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5239 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5240 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5241 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5242 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5243
5244 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5245 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5246 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5247 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5248 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5249 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5250 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5251 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5252
5253 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5254 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5255
5256 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5257 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5258 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5259
5260 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5261 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5262 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5263
5264 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5265 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5266 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5267
5268 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5269 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5270 argument, it appends to the file.
5271
5272 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5273 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5274 compatibility.
5275
5276 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5277 ring (history).
5278
5279 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5280 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5281 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5282
5283 ** Changes to Rmail mode
5284
5285 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5286 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5287 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5288 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5289 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5290 as correspondent.
5291
5292 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5293 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5294 regexp matching your mail addresses.
5295
5296 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5297 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5298 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5299 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5300 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5301
5302 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5303 like `j'.
5304
5305 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5306 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5307 digest message.
5308
5309 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5310 in which folder to put messages automatically.
5311
5312 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5313 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5314 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5315
5316 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5317 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5318
5319 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5320 use the -f option when sending mail.
5321
5322 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5323 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5324 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5325 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5326 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5327 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5328
5329 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
5330 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
5331 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
5332
5333 ** Changes to TeX mode
5334
5335 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
5336 `latex-mode'.
5337
5338 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
5339
5340 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
5341
5342 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
5343
5344 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
5345
5346 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
5347 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
5348 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
5349 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
5350 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
5351 can be edited from that buffer.
5352
5353 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
5354 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
5355 `A' to use all marked entries).
5356
5357 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
5358 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
5359
5360 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
5361 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
5362 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
5363 been cited.
5364
5365 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
5366 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
5367 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
5368 in column 1 are always made leaves.
5369
5370 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
5371 has the following new features:
5372
5373 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
5374 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
5375 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
5376 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
5377
5378 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
5379 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
5380 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
5381 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
5382 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
5383 defaults to 1.
5384
5385 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
5386 file names.
5387
5388 ** Ispell changes
5389
5390 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
5391 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
5392 spell-checks the current buffer.
5393
5394 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
5395 added.
5396
5397 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
5398 correction is made and re-checked.
5399
5400 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
5401
5402 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
5403 cases.
5404
5405 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
5406 on syntax errors.
5407
5408 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
5409 end of the buffer.
5410
5411 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5412
5413 ** Makefile mode changes
5414
5415 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
5416
5417 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
5418 Fontlock mode is active.
5419
5420 ** Isearch changes
5421
5422 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
5423 so that searches can be resumed.
5424
5425 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
5426 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
5427 that started the search.
5428
5429 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
5430 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
5431
5432 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
5433
5434 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
5435 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
5436 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
5437 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
5438 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
5439 `secondary-selection'.
5440
5441 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
5442 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
5443 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
5444 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
5445 usual snappy response.
5446
5447 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
5448 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
5449 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
5450 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
5451
5452 ** VC Changes
5453
5454 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
5455 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
5456 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
5457 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
5458 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
5459 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
5460 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
5461 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
5462 file is registered in that backend.
5463
5464 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
5465 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
5466 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
5467 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
5468 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
5469 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
5470
5471 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
5472 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
5473 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
5474 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
5475 where it doesn't make sense.)
5476
5477 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
5478 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
5479 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
5480
5481 *** General Changes
5482
5483 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
5484 checks are always done now.
5485
5486 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
5487 operations.
5488
5489 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
5490 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
5491 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
5492
5493 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
5494 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
5495 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
5496 the working file (``merge news'').
5497
5498 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5499 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
5500 downwards.
5501
5502 *** Multiple Backends
5503
5504 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
5505 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
5506 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
5507 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
5508 local RCS archives.
5509
5510 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
5511 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
5512 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
5513 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
5514
5515 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
5516 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
5517 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
5518 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
5519 current revision number from the more remote backend.
5520
5521 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
5522 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
5523 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
5524 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
5525
5526 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
5527 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
5528 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
5529 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
5530
5531 *** Changes for CVS
5532
5533 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
5534 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
5535 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
5536 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
5537 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
5538 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
5539 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
5540
5541 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
5542 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
5543 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
5544 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
5545 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
5546 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
5547 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
5548 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
5549 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
5550 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
5551 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
5552 name.)
5553
5554 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
5555 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
5556 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
5557 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
5558 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
5559 entire directory tree.
5560
5561 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
5562 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
5563 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
5564 "watched" by other developers.)
5565
5566 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5567 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
5568 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
5569 starting at the given directory.
5570
5571 *** Lisp Changes in VC
5572
5573 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
5574 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
5575 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
5576 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
5577 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
5578 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
5579 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
5580 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
5581 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
5582
5583 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
5584 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
5585 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
5586 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
5587
5588 ** New modes and packages
5589
5590 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
5591 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
5592 the default is not applicable.
5593
5594 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
5595 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
5596 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
5597
5598 Features are:
5599
5600 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
5601 drawn, like this: | \ /
5602 --+-- X
5603 | / \
5604
5605 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
5606 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
5607 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
5608 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
5609 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
5610 you are drawing.
5611
5612 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
5613 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
5614
5615 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
5616 flood-filling.
5617
5618 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
5619 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
5620 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
5621 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
5622
5623 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
5624 also do without the mouse.
5625
5626 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
5627 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
5628 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
5629 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
5630 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
5631
5632 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
5633
5634 lines straight-lines
5635 rectangles squares
5636 poly-lines straight poly-lines
5637 ellipses circles
5638 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
5639 spray-can setting size for spraying
5640 vaporize line vaporize lines
5641 erase characters erase rectangles
5642
5643 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
5644 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
5645 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
5646 drawing.
5647
5648 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
5649 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
5650 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
5651 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
5652
5653 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
5654 can be turned off).
5655
5656 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
5657 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
5658 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
5659 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
5660 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
5661 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
5662 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
5663 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
5664 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
5665
5666 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
5667 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
5668 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
5669 on certain projects.
5670
5671 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
5672 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
5673
5674 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
5675
5676 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
5677 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
5678 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
5679 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
5680 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
5681 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
5682 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
5683 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
5684
5685 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
5686 Emacs is idle.
5687
5688 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
5689 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
5690
5691 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
5692 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
5693
5694 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
5695 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
5696 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
5697 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
5698 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5699
5700 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
5701 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
5702 separate Texinfo file.
5703
5704 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
5705 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
5706 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
5707 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
5708 enter check-in log messages.
5709
5710 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
5711 without invoking external programs.
5712
5713 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
5714 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
5715 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
5716 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
5717 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
5718
5719 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
5720 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
5721
5722 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
5723 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
5724
5725 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
5726 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
5727 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
5728 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
5729 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
5730 single step.
5731
5732 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
5733 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
5734 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
5735 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
5736
5737 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
5738 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
5739 actually modifying content of a buffer.
5740
5741 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
5742 PostScript.
5743
5744 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
5745
5746 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
5747
5748 ; comment (until end of line)
5749 A non-terminal
5750 "C" terminal
5751 ?C? special
5752 $A default non-terminal
5753 $"C" default terminal
5754 $?C? default special
5755 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
5756 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
5757 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
5758 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
5759 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
5760 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
5761 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
5762 C+ one or more occurrences of C
5763 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
5764 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
5765 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
5766 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
5767 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
5768 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5769 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5770
5771 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
5772
5773 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
5774 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
5775 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
5776 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
5777 equal signs of assignments.
5778
5779 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
5780 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
5781
5782 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
5783 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
5784 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
5785
5786 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
5787
5788 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
5789 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
5790 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
5791 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
5792 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
5793 which answers different needs.
5794
5795 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
5796 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
5797 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
5798 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
5799 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
5800 to be enabled.
5801
5802 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
5803 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
5804
5805 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
5806
5807 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
5808 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
5809 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
5810
5811 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
5812
5813 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
5814 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
5815 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
5816 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
5817 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
5818 and background colors.
5819
5820 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
5821 Pascal) language.
5822
5823 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
5824 the text at point.
5825
5826 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
5827
5828 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
5829
5830 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
5831 whitespace in a file.
5832
5833 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
5834 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
5835 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
5836 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
5837 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
5838 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
5839 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
5840
5841 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
5842
5843 Here is an example of columns:
5844
5845 horse apple bus
5846 dog pineapple car EXTRA
5847 porcupine strawberry airplane
5848
5849 Doing the following settings:
5850
5851 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
5852 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
5853 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
5854 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
5855
5856
5857 Selecting the lines above and typing:
5858
5859 M-x delimit-columns-region
5860
5861 It results:
5862
5863 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
5864 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
5865 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
5866
5867 delim-col has the following options:
5868
5869 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
5870 before all columns.
5871
5872 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
5873 between each column.
5874
5875 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
5876 after all columns.
5877
5878 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
5879 each column.
5880
5881 delim-col has the following commands:
5882
5883 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
5884 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
5885
5886 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
5887 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
5888 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
5889 recent file list can be displayed:
5890
5891 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
5892 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
5893 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
5894
5895 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
5896 dynamically change the menu appearance.
5897
5898 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
5899 text.
5900
5901 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
5902 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
5903 specific to Message mode.
5904
5905 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
5906 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
5907 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
5908
5909 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
5910 interface to access directory servers using different directory
5911 protocols. It has a separate manual.
5912
5913 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
5914 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
5915
5916 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
5917
5918 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
5919 minibuffer with completion.
5920
5921 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
5922 with the diary features.
5923
5924 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
5925 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
5926
5927 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
5928 Fill mode.
5929
5930 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
5931 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
5932 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
5933 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
5934
5935 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
5936 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
5937 `.g'.
5938
5939 ** Changes in sort.el
5940
5941 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
5942 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
5943 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
5944 numeric base.
5945
5946 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
5947
5948 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
5949 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
5950 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
5951
5952 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
5953 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
5954
5955 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
5956 output ^M at the end of lines.
5957
5958 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
5959 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
5960
5961 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
5962 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
5963 `(msb-mode 1)'.
5964
5965 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
5966 group.
5967
5968 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
5969 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
5970 are recognized:
5971
5972 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
5973 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
5974 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
5975 nil -- just delete one character.
5976
5977 Default value is `untabify'.
5978
5979 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
5980
5981 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
5982 symbol, not double-quoted.
5983
5984 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
5985 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
5986 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
5987 moved to lisp/obsolete.
5988
5989 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
5990 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
5991 `auto-compression-mode' command.
5992
5993 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
5994 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
5995 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
5996
5997 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
5998 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
5999
6000 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6001 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6002
6003 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6004 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6005
6006 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6007 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6008 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6009 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6010 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6011 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6012
6013 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6014 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6015
6016 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6017
6018 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6019 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6020
6021 ** Shell script mode changes.
6022
6023 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6024 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6025 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6026
6027 ** Etags changes.
6028
6029 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6030
6031 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6032 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6033 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6034 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6035 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6036
6037 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6038 declarations when given the --declarations option.
6039
6040 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6041 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6042
6043 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6044 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6045 `template' keywords.
6046
6047 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6048 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6049
6050 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6051 types.
6052
6053 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6054
6055 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6056
6057 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6058 are now tagged.
6059
6060 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6061
6062 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6063 variables are tagged.
6064
6065 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6066
6067 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6068 for PSWrap.
6069
6070 ** Changes in etags.el
6071
6072 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6073 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6074 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6075
6076 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6077 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6078
6079 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6080 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6081 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6082 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6083
6084 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6085
6086 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6087 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6088
6089 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6090
6091 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6092 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6093 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6094
6095 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6096 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6097
6098 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6099 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6100
6101 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6102 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6103 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6104 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6105 point will go to the beginning of the file.
6106
6107 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6108 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6109 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6110
6111 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6112 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6113 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6114
6115 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6116 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6117 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6118
6119 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6120
6121 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6122
6123 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6124 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6125 expression from that list, are not checked.
6126
6127 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6128 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6129 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6130 the buffer, just like for the local files.
6131
6132 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6133
6134 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6135 displays local abbrevs, only.
6136
6137 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6138 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6139
6140 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6141 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6142 is measured in pixels.
6143
6144 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6145 to be visited as images.
6146
6147 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6148 were added to compile.el.
6149
6150 ** Withdrawn packages
6151
6152 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6153 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
6154
6155 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6156
6157 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
6158
6159 \f
6160 * Incompatible Lisp changes
6161
6162 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6163 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
6164 See the sections below for details.
6165
6166 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
6167 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
6168 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6169 to remove the properties of the copy.
6170
6171 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6172 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6173 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6174 these properties are active.
6175
6176 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
6177 ranges may affect some code.
6178
6179 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6180 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6181 make a difference to some code.
6182
6183 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6184 operates on the minibuffer.
6185
6186 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6187 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6188 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6189 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6190 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6191 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6192 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6193 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6194 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6195 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6196 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6197 the buffer as multibyte characters.
6198
6199 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6200 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6201 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6202
6203 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
6204 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6205 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
6206
6207 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
6208 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6209 such as `mapconcat'.
6210
6211 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6212 string.
6213
6214 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6215 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6216 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6217 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6218 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6219 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
6220 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6221 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
6222
6223 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6224 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6225 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6226 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6227 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6228 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6229 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6230 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6231 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6232 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
6233
6234 \f
6235 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6236 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6237
6238 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6239
6240 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
6241 allows the animated display of strings.
6242
6243 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6244 interactive form of a function.
6245
6246 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6247 between custom options. Example:
6248
6249 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6250 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6251 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6252 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6253 :group 'mule
6254 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6255 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6256
6257 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6258 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6259 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6260
6261 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
6262 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6263 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6264 (signal or normal termination).
6265
6266 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6267 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6268
6269 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6270 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6271
6272 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6273 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6274
6275 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
6276
6277 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6278 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6279 being deleted.
6280
6281 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6282
6283 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
6284 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6285 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6286 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6287 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6288 charset.
6289
6290 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6291 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6292 message.
6293
6294 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6295 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6296
6297 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6298 with the more general `:mask' property.
6299
6300 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
6301
6302 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6303 backslash.
6304
6305 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6306 is running in batch mode. For example,
6307
6308 (message "%s" (read t))
6309
6310 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6311 to standard output.
6312
6313 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6314 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6315
6316 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6317 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6318 frame or window.
6319
6320 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6321 were added
6322
6323 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
6324
6325 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
6326 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6327
6328 - Function: remq ELT LIST
6329
6330 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
6331 comparison is done with `eq'.
6332
6333 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
6334
6335 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
6336 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
6337 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
6338
6339 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
6340 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
6341 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
6342
6343 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
6344 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
6345
6346 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
6347 function was declared obsolete.
6348
6349 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
6350 retained as an alias).
6351
6352 ** Easy-menu's :filter now works as in XEmacs.
6353 It takes the unconverted (i.e. XEmacs) form of the menu and the result
6354 is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
6355
6356 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
6357
6358 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
6359
6360 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
6361 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
6362 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
6363 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
6364 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
6365 means never include the minibuffer window.
6366
6367 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
6368
6369 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
6370
6371 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
6372
6373 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
6374 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
6375 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
6376 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
6377 returned.
6378
6379 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
6380 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
6381 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
6382 minibuffer even if it is active.
6383
6384 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
6385 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
6386 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
6387 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
6388 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
6389 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
6390
6391 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
6392 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
6393 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
6394 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
6395 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
6396 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
6397 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
6398
6399 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
6400 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
6401 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
6402
6403 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
6404 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
6405 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
6406 Default value is nil.
6407
6408 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
6409 meaning no limit.
6410
6411 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
6412 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
6413 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
6414
6415 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
6416 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
6417 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
6418
6419 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
6420 list of a primitive.
6421
6422 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
6423
6424 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
6425 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
6426 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
6427 than replacing the local map.
6428
6429 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
6430 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
6431 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
6432 instead.
6433
6434 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
6435
6436 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
6437 as promised long ago.
6438
6439 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
6440
6441 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
6442 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
6443 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
6444
6445 \f
6446 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
6447
6448 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
6449 regular expressions.
6450
6451 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
6452
6453 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6454
6455 - Macro: rx SEXP
6456
6457 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6458
6459 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
6460 notation.
6461
6462 STRING
6463 matches string STRING literally.
6464
6465 CHAR
6466 matches character CHAR literally.
6467
6468 `not-newline'
6469 matches any character except a newline.
6470 .
6471 `anything'
6472 matches any character
6473
6474 `(any SET)'
6475 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
6476 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
6477
6478 '(in SET)'
6479 like `any'.
6480
6481 `(not (any SET))'
6482 matches any character not in SET
6483
6484 `line-start'
6485 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
6486 in the text being matched
6487
6488 `line-end'
6489 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
6490
6491 `string-start'
6492 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6493 string being matched against.
6494
6495 `string-end'
6496 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6497 string being matched against.
6498
6499 `buffer-start'
6500 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6501 buffer being matched against.
6502
6503 `buffer-end'
6504 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6505 buffer being matched against.
6506
6507 `point'
6508 matches the empty string, but only at point.
6509
6510 `word-start'
6511 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6512 word.
6513
6514 `word-end'
6515 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
6516
6517 `word-boundary'
6518 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6519 word.
6520
6521 `(not word-boundary)'
6522 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
6523 word.
6524
6525 `digit'
6526 matches 0 through 9.
6527
6528 `control'
6529 matches ASCII control characters.
6530
6531 `hex-digit'
6532 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6533
6534 `blank'
6535 matches space and tab only.
6536
6537 `graphic'
6538 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6539 space, and DEL.
6540
6541 `printing'
6542 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6543 and DEL.
6544
6545 `alphanumeric'
6546 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6547 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6548
6549 `letter'
6550 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6551 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6552
6553 `ascii'
6554 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6555
6556 `nonascii'
6557 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6558
6559 `lower'
6560 matches anything lower-case.
6561
6562 `upper'
6563 matches anything upper-case.
6564
6565 `punctuation'
6566 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6567 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6568
6569 `space'
6570 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6571
6572 `word'
6573 matches anything that has word syntax.
6574
6575 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
6576 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
6577 of the following symbols.
6578
6579 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
6580 `punctuation' (\\s.)
6581 `word' (\\sw)
6582 `symbol' (\\s_)
6583 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
6584 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
6585 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
6586 `string-quote' (\\s\")
6587 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
6588 `escape' (\\s\\)
6589 `character-quote' (\\s/)
6590 `comment-start' (\\s<)
6591 `comment-end' (\\s>)
6592
6593 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
6594 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
6595
6596 `(category CATEGORY)'
6597 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
6598 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
6599
6600 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
6601 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
6602 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
6603 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
6604 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
6605 `symbol' (\\c5)
6606 `digit' (\\c6)
6607 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
6608 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
6609 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
6610 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
6611 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
6612 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
6613 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
6614 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
6615 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
6616 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6617 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
6618 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
6619 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
6620 `ascii' (\\ca)
6621 `arabic' (\\cb)
6622 `chinese' (\\cc)
6623 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
6624 `greek' (\\cg)
6625 `korean' (\\ch)
6626 `indian' (\\ci)
6627 `japanese' (\\cj)
6628 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
6629 `latin' (\\cl)
6630 `lao' (\\co)
6631 `tibetan' (\\cq)
6632 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
6633 `thai' (\\ct)
6634 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
6635 `hebrew' (\\cw)
6636 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
6637 `can-break' (\\c|)
6638
6639 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
6640 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
6641
6642 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6643 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
6644
6645 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6646 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
6647 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
6648
6649 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6650 another name for `submatch'.
6651
6652 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6653 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
6654 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
6655 regular expression.
6656
6657 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
6658 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
6659 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6660 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
6661 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
6662
6663 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
6664 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6665
6666 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
6667 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6668
6669 `(0+ SEXP)'
6670 like `zero-or-more'.
6671
6672 `(* SEXP)'
6673 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6674
6675 `(*? SEXP)'
6676 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6677
6678 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
6679 matches one or more occurrences of A.
6680
6681 `(1+ SEXP)'
6682 like `one-or-more'.
6683
6684 `(+ SEXP)'
6685 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6686
6687 `(+? SEXP)'
6688 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6689
6690 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
6691 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
6692
6693 `(optional SEXP)'
6694 like `zero-or-one'.
6695
6696 `(? SEXP)'
6697 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6698
6699 `(?? SEXP)'
6700 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6701
6702 `(repeat N SEXP)'
6703 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6704
6705 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
6706 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6707
6708 `(eval FORM)'
6709 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6710 `regexp-quote' it.
6711
6712 `(regexp REGEXP)'
6713 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
6714
6715 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
6716
6717 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
6718 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
6719 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
6720 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
6721
6722 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
6723 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
6724 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
6725 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
6726
6727 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
6728 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
6729 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
6730
6731 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
6732 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
6733 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
6734 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
6735 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
6736 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
6737 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
6738 eight-bit-graphic.
6739
6740 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
6741
6742 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
6743 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
6744 character set as previously.
6745
6746 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
6747 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
6748 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
6749
6750 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
6751 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
6752 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
6753 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
6754
6755 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
6756 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
6757
6758 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
6759 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
6760 "fontset-default".
6761
6762 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
6763 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
6764
6765 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
6766 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
6767 buffers and strings.
6768
6769 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
6770 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
6771 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
6772 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
6773 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
6774 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
6775 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
6776 also been deleted.
6777
6778 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
6779 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
6780 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
6781
6782 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
6783 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
6784 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
6785 may differ between buffer and string text.
6786
6787 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
6788 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
6789
6790 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
6791 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
6792 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
6793 `composition' from STRING.
6794
6795 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
6796 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
6797
6798 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
6799 obsolete.
6800
6801 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
6802 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
6803
6804 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
6805 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
6806 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
6807 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
6808
6809 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
6810 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
6811 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
6812 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
6813 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
6814 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
6815
6816 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
6817 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
6818 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
6819
6820 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
6821 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
6822 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
6823
6824 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
6825 have been introduced.
6826
6827 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6828 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
6829 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
6830 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
6831 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
6832 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
6833 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
6834 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
6835 their multibyte equivalent.
6836
6837 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
6838 that offset in the file before writing.
6839
6840 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
6841 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
6842
6843 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
6844 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
6845 from which the command was issued.
6846
6847 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
6848 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
6849 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
6850 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
6851 operate on.
6852
6853 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
6854 to `window-buffer-height'.
6855
6856 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
6857
6858 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
6859 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
6860 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
6861
6862 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
6863 respectively.
6864
6865 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
6866 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
6867
6868 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
6869 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
6870 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
6871
6872 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
6873 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
6874 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
6875 is currently displayed in some window.
6876
6877 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
6878 argument function's results.
6879
6880 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
6881 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
6882 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
6883 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
6884 sequence).
6885
6886 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
6887 header in the list of headers passed to it.
6888
6889 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
6890 ignores differences in case and text representation.
6891
6892 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
6893 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
6894 as follows:
6895
6896 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
6897 nil don't display a cursor
6898 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
6899 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
6900 others display a box cursor.
6901
6902 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
6903 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
6904 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
6905 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
6906
6907 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
6908 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
6909 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
6910 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
6911
6912 Example:
6913
6914 (string-to-syntax "()")
6915 => (4 . 41)
6916
6917 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
6918 other than 10.
6919
6920 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
6921 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
6922
6923 #b1111
6924 => 15
6925 #b-1111
6926 => -15
6927
6928 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
6929
6930 #o666
6931 => 438
6932
6933 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
6934
6935 #xbeef
6936 => 48815
6937
6938 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
6939
6940 #2R-111
6941 => -7
6942 #25rah
6943 => 267
6944
6945 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
6946 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
6947 and isn't a string.
6948
6949 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
6950 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
6951 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
6952 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
6953
6954 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
6955
6956 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
6957 for a regexp in a string.
6958
6959 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
6960 `mouse-position-function'.
6961
6962 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
6963 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
6964
6965 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
6966 Keywords are now always considered constants.
6967
6968 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
6969 returns it.
6970
6971 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
6972 returned by function `recent-keys'.
6973
6974 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
6975 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
6976 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
6977 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
6978 mode.
6979
6980 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
6981 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
6982
6983 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
6984 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
6985 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
6986 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
6987 been performed."
6988
6989 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
6990 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
6991 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
6992 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
6993
6994 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
6995 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
6996 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
6997
6998 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
6999 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7000 specified table.
7001
7002 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7003
7004 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
7005 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7006 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7007 what BODY returns.
7008
7009 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
7010 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
7011 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
7012 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7013 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
7014
7015 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7016 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7017
7018 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7019 instead of being optional.
7020
7021 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7022 modify read-only text.
7023
7024 ** New functions and variables for locales.
7025
7026 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7027 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
7028 time functions like strftime. The new variables
7029 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7030 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
7031
7032 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7033 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7034 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
7035 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7036 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7037 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7038 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
7039
7040 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7041 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7042 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7043 start sequences.
7044
7045 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7046 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7047
7048 ** New function `propertize'
7049
7050 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7051 strings with text properties.
7052
7053 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7054
7055 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7056 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7057 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7058 specified value of that property. Example:
7059
7060 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7061
7062 ** push and pop macros.
7063
7064 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7065 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
7066 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7067
7068 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7069 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7070 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7071
7072 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7073
7074 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7075 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
7076
7077 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7078 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7079 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7080 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7081
7082 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7083 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7084 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7085 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7086
7087 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7088 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7089 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7090 or a sign.
7091
7092 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7093 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7094 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7095 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
7096 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7097 space, and DEL.
7098 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7099 and DEL.
7100 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7101 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7102 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7103 [:alpha:] matches letters.
7104 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7105 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7106 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7107 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7108 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7109 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
7110 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7111 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7112 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7113 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7114 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7115
7116 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7117
7118 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7119
7120 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7121
7122 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7123 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7124
7125 :test TEST
7126
7127 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7128 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7129 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7130
7131 :size SIZE
7132
7133 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7134 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7135
7136 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7137
7138 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7139 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7140 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
7141 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7142 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7143
7144 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7145
7146 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7147 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7148 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7149
7150 :weakness WEAK
7151
7152 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7153 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7154 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7155 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7156 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
7157
7158 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
7159
7160 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7161
7162 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7163
7164 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7165
7166 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7167
7168 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7169 values are shared.
7170
7171 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7172
7173 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7174
7175 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7176
7177 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7178
7179 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7180
7181 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7182
7183 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7184
7185 Returns the size of TABLE.
7186
7187 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
7188
7189 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7190
7191 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7192
7193 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7194
7195 - Function: clrhash TABLE
7196
7197 Clear TABLE.
7198
7199 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7200
7201 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7202 not found.
7203
7204 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
7205
7206 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7207 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7208
7209 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7210
7211 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7212
7213 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7214
7215 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7216 arguments KEY and VALUE.
7217
7218 - Function: sxhash OBJ
7219
7220 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7221
7222 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7223
7224 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7225 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
7226 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
7227 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7228 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7229
7230 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7231
7232 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7233 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7234 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7235
7236 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7237 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7238
7239 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7240 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7241
7242 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7243 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7244
7245 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
7246 'case-fold-string-hash))
7247
7248 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7249
7250 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7251
7252 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7253 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7254 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7255
7256 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7257
7258 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7259 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7260
7261 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7262 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7263 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7264 is too short to reach that column.
7265
7266 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7267 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7268 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7269 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7270
7271 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7272 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7273 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7274
7275 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7276 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7277
7278 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7279 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7280
7281 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7282 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7283 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7284 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7285 temporary-file-directory instead.
7286
7287 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7288 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7289 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7290 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7291
7292 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7293 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
7294
7295 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7296
7297 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7298 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7299 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7300
7301 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7302
7303 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7304 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7305 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7306 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7307 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7308 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7309
7310 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7311 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7312 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7313 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7314
7315 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7316
7317 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7318 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7319 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7320 result string.
7321
7322 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7323 string where arguments appear in the result string.
7324
7325 Example:
7326
7327 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7328 (s2 "world"))
7329 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7330 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
7331 (format s1 s2))
7332
7333 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
7334
7335 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
7336
7337 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
7338 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
7339 argument in it.
7340
7341 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
7342 (arg "world"))
7343 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
7344 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
7345 (message msg arg))
7346
7347 ** Sound support
7348
7349 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
7350 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
7351
7352 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
7353 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
7354 to enable sound support.
7355
7356 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
7357 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
7358 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
7359 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
7360 sound to play, before playing the sound.
7361
7362 The following sound properties are supported:
7363
7364 - `:file FILE'
7365
7366 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
7367 searched relative to `data-directory'.
7368
7369 - `:data DATA'
7370
7371 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
7372 may be present, but not both.
7373
7374 - `:volume VOLUME'
7375
7376 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
7377 0..1. This property is optional.
7378
7379 - `:device DEVICE'
7380
7381 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
7382 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
7383
7384 Other properties are ignored.
7385
7386 An alternative interface is called as
7387 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
7388
7389 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
7390
7391 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
7392 a keyword symbol.
7393
7394 ** Changes to garbage collection
7395
7396 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
7397 of live and free strings.
7398
7399 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
7400 strings that have been consed so far.
7401
7402 \f
7403 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
7404 Lisp Manual
7405
7406 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
7407 mini-windows.
7408
7409 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
7410 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
7411 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
7412
7413 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
7414
7415 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
7416
7417 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
7418 image.
7419
7420 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
7421
7422 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
7423
7424 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
7425 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
7426 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
7427 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
7428 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
7429
7430 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
7431 has a mask bitmap.
7432
7433 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
7434
7435 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
7436 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
7437 or omitted means use the selected frame.
7438
7439 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
7440 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
7441
7442 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
7443 optional.
7444
7445 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
7446 below).
7447
7448 \f
7449 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
7450
7451 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
7452 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
7453
7454 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
7455 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
7456 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
7457 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
7458 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
7459 just display it black instead.
7460
7461 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
7462 a line like
7463
7464 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
7465
7466 in your `.emacs'.
7467
7468 ** New face implementation.
7469
7470 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
7471 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
7472
7473 *** New faces.
7474
7475 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
7476
7477 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
7478
7479 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
7480 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
7481
7482 3. Font height in 1/10pt
7483
7484 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
7485
7486 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
7487
7488 6. Foreground color.
7489
7490 7. Background color.
7491
7492 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
7493
7494 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
7495
7496 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
7497
7498 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
7499
7500 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
7501 color.
7502
7503 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
7504 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
7505
7506 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
7507 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
7508 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
7509 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
7510 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
7511 attributes mentioned above.
7512
7513 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
7514 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
7515 created frames.
7516
7517 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
7518 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
7519 `fully-specified'.
7520
7521 *** Face merging.
7522
7523 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
7524 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
7525 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
7526 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
7527 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
7528 results in a fully-specified face.
7529
7530 *** Face realization.
7531
7532 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
7533 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
7534 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
7535 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
7536 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
7537 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
7538
7539 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
7540 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
7541 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
7542 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
7543
7544 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
7545 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
7546 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
7547 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
7548 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
7549
7550 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
7551 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
7552 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
7553 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
7554 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
7555 Emacs.
7556
7557 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
7558 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
7559 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
7560 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
7561
7562 **** Clearing face caches.
7563
7564 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
7565 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
7566 unused fonts.
7567
7568 *** Font selection.
7569
7570 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
7571 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
7572 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
7573
7574 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
7575 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
7576 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
7577 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
7578 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
7579
7580 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
7581 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
7582 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
7583
7584 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
7585
7586 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
7587 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
7588 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
7589 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
7590 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
7591 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
7592 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
7593
7594 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7595 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
7596 doesn't exist.
7597
7598 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7599 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
7600 registry.
7601
7602 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
7603 slightly different.
7604
7605 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
7606
7607
7608 **** Scalable fonts
7609
7610 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
7611 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
7612 servers.
7613
7614 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
7615 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
7616 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
7617 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
7618 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
7619 that list. Example:
7620
7621 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
7622
7623 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
7624
7625 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
7626
7627 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
7628
7629 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
7630 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
7631 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
7632
7633 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
7634 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
7635 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
7636 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
7637 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
7638 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
7639 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
7640 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
7641 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
7642 of the face font sort order.
7643
7644 - Function: x-font-family-list
7645
7646 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
7647 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
7648 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
7649 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
7650
7651 - Variable: font-list-limit
7652
7653 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
7654 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
7655 matching font. The default is currently 100.
7656
7657 *** Setting face attributes.
7658
7659 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
7660 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
7661 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
7662 `face-attribute'.
7663
7664 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
7665 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
7666
7667 The following attributes are recognized:
7668
7669 `:family'
7670
7671 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
7672 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
7673 and `?' are allowed.
7674
7675 `:width'
7676
7677 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
7678 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
7679 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
7680 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
7681
7682 `:height'
7683
7684 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
7685 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
7686 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
7687 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
7688
7689 `:weight'
7690
7691 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
7692 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
7693 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
7694
7695 `:slant'
7696
7697 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
7698 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
7699 `reverse-oblique'.
7700
7701 `:foreground', `:background'
7702
7703 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
7704
7705 `:underline'
7706
7707 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
7708 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
7709 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
7710 don't underline.
7711
7712 `:overline'
7713
7714 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
7715 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
7716 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
7717 overline.
7718
7719 `:strike-through'
7720
7721 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
7722 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
7723 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
7724 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
7725
7726 `:box'
7727
7728 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
7729 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
7730 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
7731 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
7732 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
7733 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
7734 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
7735 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
7736 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
7737 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
7738 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
7739 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
7740 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
7741 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
7742 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
7743 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
7744 box.
7745
7746 `:inverse-video'
7747
7748 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
7749 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
7750
7751 `:stipple'
7752
7753 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
7754 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
7755 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
7756 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
7757 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
7758 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
7759
7760 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
7761 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
7762
7763 `:font'
7764
7765 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
7766 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
7767 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
7768 versions of Emacs.
7769
7770 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
7771 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
7772 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
7773
7774 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
7775 `defface'.
7776
7777 `:inherit'
7778
7779 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
7780 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
7781 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
7782
7783 *** Face attributes and X resources
7784
7785 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
7786 from X resources:
7787
7788 Face attribute X resource class
7789 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
7790 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
7791 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
7792 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
7793 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
7794 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
7795 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
7796 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
7797 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
7798 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
7799 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
7800 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
7801 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
7802 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
7803 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
7804 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
7805 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7806 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
7807 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
7808 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7809
7810 *** Text property `face'.
7811
7812 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
7813 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
7814 specification can be
7815
7816 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
7817
7818 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
7819 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
7820 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
7821 for face attribute names.
7822
7823 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
7824 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
7825 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
7826
7827 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
7828
7829 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
7830 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
7831 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
7832 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
7833 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
7834 used to clear the mapping table.
7835
7836 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
7837
7838 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
7839 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
7840 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
7841 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
7842 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
7843 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
7844 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
7845 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
7846 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
7847 modify their color-related behavior.
7848
7849 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
7850 any frame type.
7851
7852 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
7853
7854 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
7855 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
7856 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
7857 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
7858 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
7859 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
7860 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
7861 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
7862 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
7863
7864 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
7865 display can display image files.
7866
7867 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
7868
7869 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
7870 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
7871 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
7872 `Inviolable' option.
7873
7874 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
7875 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
7876 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
7877
7878 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
7879
7880 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
7881 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
7882 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
7883
7884 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
7885 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
7886 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
7887 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
7888 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
7889 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
7890 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
7891 functions.
7892
7893 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
7894 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
7895 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
7896
7897 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
7898
7899 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
7900
7901 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
7902
7903 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7904 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
7905 constrained position if that is different.
7906
7907 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
7908 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
7909 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
7910 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
7911 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7912 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
7913 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
7914 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
7915 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
7916
7917 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
7918 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
7919 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
7920 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
7921 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
7922
7923 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
7924 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
7925
7926 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
7927
7928 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
7929
7930 Delete the field surrounding POS.
7931 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7932 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7933
7934 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7935
7936 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
7937 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7938 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7939 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
7940 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
7941
7942 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7943
7944 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
7945 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7946 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7947 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
7948 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
7949
7950 - Function: field-string &optional POS
7951
7952 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
7953 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7954 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7955
7956 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
7957
7958 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
7959 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7960 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7961
7962 ** Image support.
7963
7964 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
7965 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
7966 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
7967 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
7968
7969 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
7970 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
7971 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
7972 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
7973 area.
7974
7975 IMAGE is an image specification.
7976
7977 *** Image specifications
7978
7979 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
7980 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
7981 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
7982 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
7983 described below are ignored.
7984
7985 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
7986
7987 `:ascent ASCENT'
7988
7989 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
7990 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
7991 to use for its ascent.
7992
7993 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
7994 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
7995
7996 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
7997 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
7998 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
7999 overlays that apply to the image.
8000
8001 `:margin MARGIN'
8002
8003 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8004 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8005 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
8006
8007 `:relief RELIEF'
8008
8009 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8010 around an image.
8011
8012 `:conversion ALGO'
8013
8014 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8015
8016 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8017 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8018
8019 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8020 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8021 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8022 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8023 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8024 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8025 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8026 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8027 below.
8028
8029 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8030 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8031 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8032
8033 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8034 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8035 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8036 of the factors' absolute values.
8037
8038 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
8039
8040 (1 0 0
8041 0 0 0
8042 9 9 -1)
8043
8044 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8045
8046 ( 2 -1 0
8047 -1 0 1
8048 0 1 -2)
8049
8050 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8051 ``disabled''.
8052
8053 `:mask MASK'
8054
8055 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8056 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8057 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8058 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8059 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
8060 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8061 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8062 image.
8063
8064 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8065 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8066 `:mask nil'.
8067
8068 `:file FILE'
8069
8070 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8071 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8072 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8073 may be present in the image specification.
8074
8075 `:data DATA'
8076
8077 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8078 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8079 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8080 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8081
8082 *** Supported image types
8083
8084 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
8085
8086 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
8087 properties supported are:
8088
8089 `:foreground FG'
8090
8091 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8092 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8093
8094 `:background BG'
8095
8096 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8097 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8098
8099 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8100 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8101 instead of a `:file' property.
8102
8103 `:width WIDTH'
8104
8105 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8106
8107 `:height HEIGHT'
8108
8109 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8110
8111 `:data DATA'
8112
8113 DATA must be either
8114
8115 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8116 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8117
8118 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8119
8120 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8121 bitmap.
8122
8123 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8124 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8125 in the file.
8126
8127 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
8128
8129 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8130 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8131 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8132 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8133
8134 Additional image properties supported are:
8135
8136 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8137
8138 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8139 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8140 name.
8141
8142 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8143 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8144
8145 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8146 to display compressed images.
8147
8148 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
8149
8150 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
8151 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
8152 mono images are:
8153
8154 `:foreground FG'
8155
8156 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8157 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8158
8159 `:background FG'
8160
8161 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8162 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8163
8164 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8165
8166 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
8167 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8168 properties defined.
8169
8170 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8171
8172 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8173 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8174 properties defined.
8175
8176 **** GIF, image type `gif'
8177
8178 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8179 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8180
8181 Additional image properties supported are:
8182
8183 `:index INDEX'
8184
8185 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
8186 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8187 as a hollow box.
8188
8189 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8190 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8191 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8192 every 0.1 seconds.
8193
8194 (defun show-anim (file max)
8195 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8196 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8197
8198 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8199 (when (= idx max)
8200 (setq idx 0))
8201 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
8202 (save-excursion
8203 (set-buffer buffer)
8204 (goto-char (point-min))
8205 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8206 (insert-image img "x"))
8207 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8208
8209 **** PNG, image type `png'
8210
8211 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8212 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8213 properties defined.
8214
8215 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8216
8217 Additional image properties supported are:
8218
8219 `:pt-width WIDTH'
8220
8221 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
8222 integer. This is a required property.
8223
8224 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
8225
8226 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
8227 must be a integer. This is an required property.
8228
8229 `:bounding-box BOX'
8230
8231 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8232 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8233 files. This is an required property.
8234
8235 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8236 lisp/gs.el.
8237
8238 *** Lisp interface.
8239
8240 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8241 which are supported in the current configuration.
8242
8243 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8244 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8245 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
8246 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8247 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
8248
8249 *** Simplified image API, image.el
8250
8251 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8252 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8253 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8254 define an image based on available image types. The functions
8255 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8256 buffer.
8257
8258 ** Display margins.
8259
8260 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8261 and images.
8262
8263 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8264 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8265 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8266 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8267 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8268 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8269 of the display margins.
8270
8271 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8272 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8273 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8274 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8275 in this file).
8276
8277 ** Help display
8278
8279 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8280 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8281 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8282 that have a `help-echo' property.
8283
8284 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
8285 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
8286 the window in which the help was found.
8287
8288 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8289 `help-echo' text property was found.
8290
8291 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8292 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8293
8294 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
8295 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
8296 mouse.
8297
8298 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8299 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8300
8301 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8302 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8303 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8304 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8305 used as help string.
8306
8307 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
8308 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8309 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
8310
8311 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8312
8313 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8314 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8315
8316 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8317 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8318 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8319 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8320 used.
8321
8322 (global-set-key [A-down]
8323 #'(lambda ()
8324 (interactive)
8325 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8326 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
8327 (global-set-key [A-up]
8328 #'(lambda ()
8329 (interactive)
8330 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8331 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
8332
8333 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
8334
8335 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
8336 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
8337 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
8338 is called with one argument, POS.
8339
8340 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
8341 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
8342 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
8343 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
8344 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
8345
8346 ** Tool bar support.
8347
8348 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
8349 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
8350 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
8351 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
8352 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
8353 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
8354
8355 *** Tool bar item definitions
8356
8357 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
8358 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
8359 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
8360
8361 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
8362 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
8363 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
8364 property (see below).
8365
8366 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
8367 binding are currently ignored.
8368
8369 The following properties are recognized:
8370
8371 `:enable FORM'.
8372
8373 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
8374 or disabled.
8375
8376 `:visible FORM'
8377
8378 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
8379
8380 `:filter FUNCTION'
8381
8382 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
8383 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
8384 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
8385
8386 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
8387
8388 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
8389 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
8390
8391 `:image IMAGES'
8392
8393 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
8394 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
8395 meaning of each of the four elements:
8396
8397 Index Use when item is
8398 ----------------------------------------
8399 0 enabled and selected
8400 1 enabled and deselected
8401 2 disabled and selected
8402 3 disabled and deselected
8403
8404 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
8405 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
8406
8407 `:help HELP-STRING'.
8408
8409 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
8410 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
8411
8412 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
8413 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
8414 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
8415 menu bar.
8416
8417 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
8418 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
8419 buffer-locally to override the global map.
8420
8421 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
8422
8423 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
8424 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
8425 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
8426
8427 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
8428 raised when the mouse moves over them.
8429
8430 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
8431 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
8432 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
8433 vertical margins . Default is 1.
8434
8435 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
8436 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
8437
8438 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
8439
8440 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
8441 a tool bar item. If
8442
8443 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
8444 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
8445 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
8446
8447 is the original tool bar item definition, then
8448
8449 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
8450
8451 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
8452 item.
8453
8454 ** Mode line changes.
8455
8456 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
8457
8458 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
8459 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
8460 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
8461
8462 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
8463 a `local-map' text property.
8464
8465 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
8466 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
8467
8468 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
8469 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
8470 `local-map' property.
8471
8472 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
8473 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
8474 example.
8475
8476 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
8477 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
8478
8479 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
8480 variable mode-line-format to nil.
8481
8482 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
8483
8484 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
8485 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
8486 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
8487 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
8488 line.
8489
8490 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
8491 `header-line'.
8492
8493 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
8494 position in the header-line.
8495
8496 ** Text property `display'
8497
8498 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
8499 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
8500 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
8501 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
8502 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
8503
8504 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
8505
8506 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
8507 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
8508
8509 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
8510 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
8511 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
8512 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8513 simpler form STRING as property value.
8514
8515 *** Variable width and height spaces
8516
8517 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
8518 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
8519 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
8520 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
8521 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
8522 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8523 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
8524
8525 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
8526 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
8527 properties described below.
8528
8529 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
8530 characters having the `display' property.
8531
8532 - :width WIDTH
8533
8534 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
8535 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
8536
8537 - :relative-width FACTOR
8538
8539 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
8540 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
8541 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
8542 width of that character by FACTOR.
8543
8544 - :align-to HPOS
8545
8546 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
8547 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
8548
8549 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
8550
8551 - :height HEIGHT
8552
8553 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
8554 normal line height.
8555
8556 - :relative-height FACTOR
8557
8558 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
8559 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
8560
8561 - :ascent ASCENT
8562
8563 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
8564 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
8565 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
8566 equal to 100.
8567
8568 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
8569
8570 *** Images
8571
8572 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
8573 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
8574 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
8575 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
8576 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
8577 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
8578 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
8579 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
8580 as display specification.
8581
8582 *** Other display properties
8583
8584 - (space-width FACTOR)
8585
8586 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
8587 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
8588 integer or float.
8589
8590 - (height HEIGHT)
8591
8592 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
8593
8594 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
8595 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
8596 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
8597 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
8598 a font is available counts as a step.
8599
8600 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
8601 as tall as the frame's default font.
8602
8603 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
8604 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
8605
8606 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
8607 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
8608
8609 - (raise FACTOR)
8610
8611 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
8612 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
8613 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
8614 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
8615 `height' subproperty.
8616
8617 *** Conditional display properties
8618
8619 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
8620 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
8621 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
8622 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
8623 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
8624 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
8625 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
8626 different when object is a string.
8627
8628 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
8629 `(when t . SPEC)'.
8630
8631 ** New menu separator types.
8632
8633 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
8634 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
8635 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
8636 to specify other menu separator types.
8637
8638 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
8639
8640 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
8641 separator occurs.
8642
8643 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
8644
8645 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
8646
8647 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
8648
8649 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
8650
8651 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
8652
8653 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8654
8655 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
8656
8657 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8658
8659 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
8660
8661 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
8662 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
8663
8664 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
8665
8666 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
8667
8668 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
8669
8670 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
8671
8672 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
8673
8674 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
8675
8676 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
8677
8678 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8679
8680 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
8681
8682 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
8683
8684 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
8685
8686 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8687
8688 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
8689
8690 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
8691
8692 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
8693 the corresponding single-line separators.
8694
8695 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
8696
8697 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
8698 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
8699 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
8700 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
8701 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
8702 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
8703 default foreground is black.
8704
8705 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
8706 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
8707 `ScrollBarBackground').
8708
8709 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
8710 settings for scroll bar colors.
8711
8712 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
8713 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
8714
8715 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
8716 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
8717 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
8718 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
8719 the original window start.
8720
8721 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
8722 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
8723 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
8724
8725 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
8726
8727 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
8728 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
8729 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
8730 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
8731
8732 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
8733 fixed-width and fixed-height.
8734
8735 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
8736
8737 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
8738 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
8739 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
8740 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
8741 temporarily to nil, for example
8742
8743 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
8744 (enlarge-window 10))
8745
8746 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
8747 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
8748
8749 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
8750 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
8751 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
8752 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
8753 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
8754 support a vertical-bar cursor).
8755
8756
8757 \f
8758 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
8759
8760 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
8761 input.
8762
8763 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
8764
8765 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
8766
8767 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
8768 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
8769 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
8770 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
8771 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
8772
8773 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
8774 been added.
8775
8776 \f
8777 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
8778
8779 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
8780
8781
8782 \f
8783 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
8784
8785 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
8786 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
8787 \f
8788 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
8789
8790 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
8791
8792 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
8793 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
8794 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
8795
8796 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
8797 is the one that is used.
8798
8799 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
8800 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
8801 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
8802 separate from the command's regular output.
8803 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
8804 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
8805 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
8806 the buffer name.
8807
8808 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
8809 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
8810 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
8811 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
8812
8813 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
8814 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
8815 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
8816 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
8817
8818 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
8819 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
8820 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
8821 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
8822
8823 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
8824 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
8825 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
8826 they never ignore case.
8827
8828 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
8829 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
8830 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
8831 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
8832 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
8833 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
8834 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
8835
8836 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
8837 the same format that was used in the file before.
8838
8839 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
8840 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
8841
8842 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
8843 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
8844 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
8845
8846 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
8847 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
8848 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
8849 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
8850 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
8851 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
8852 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
8853
8854 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
8855 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
8856 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
8857 format. You can now customize these variables.
8858
8859 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
8860 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
8861 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
8862 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
8863
8864 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
8865 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
8866 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
8867
8868 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
8869 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
8870 doesn't have any effect.
8871
8872 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
8873 not one per buffer.
8874
8875 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
8876 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
8877 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
8878
8879 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
8880 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
8881 `auto-show-mode' command.
8882
8883 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
8884 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
8885 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
8886 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
8887 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
8888
8889 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
8890 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
8891
8892 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
8893 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
8894 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
8895
8896 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
8897 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
8898 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
8899 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
8900
8901 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
8902
8903 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
8904 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
8905 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
8906 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
8907 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
8908
8909 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
8910 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
8911
8912 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
8913 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
8914 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
8915 `?' on other systems.
8916
8917 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
8918 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
8919 Unix.
8920
8921 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
8922 current codepage when it starts.
8923
8924 ** Mail changes
8925
8926 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
8927 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
8928 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
8929 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
8930 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
8931 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
8932 latin-1:
8933
8934 MIME-version: 1.0
8935 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
8936 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
8937
8938 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
8939 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
8940 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
8941 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
8942 buffer-file-coding-system.
8943
8944 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
8945 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
8946 mail.
8947
8948 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
8949 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
8950 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
8951 list of possible coding systems.
8952
8953 ** CC Mode changes
8954
8955 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
8956 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
8957 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
8958 docstring for details.
8959
8960 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
8961 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
8962 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
8963 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
8964 lineup functions use this feature currently.
8965
8966 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
8967 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
8968
8969 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
8970 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
8971
8972 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
8973 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
8974 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
8975 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
8976 anonymous classes.
8977
8978 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
8979 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
8980
8981 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
8982 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
8983 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
8984 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
8985
8986 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
8987 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
8988 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
8989 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
8990 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
8991
8992 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
8993
8994 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
8995
8996 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
8997 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
8998
8999 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9000
9001 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9002 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9003 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9004 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9005 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9006
9007 ** Gnus changes.
9008
9009 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9010 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9011 Gnus manual for the full story.
9012
9013 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9014 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9015 group, which is created automatically.
9016
9017 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9018 values.
9019
9020 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9021
9022 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9023 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9024
9025 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9026 `C-u C-c C-c'.
9027
9028 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9029
9030 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9031 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9032
9033 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9034
9035 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9036 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9037
9038 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9039 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9040
9041 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9042 control over simplification.
9043
9044 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9045
9046 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9047 limit.
9048
9049 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9050
9051 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9052
9053 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9054 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9055 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9056
9057 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
9058 `a' forces normal posting method.
9059
9060 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9061 -- `W d'.
9062
9063 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9064 to a non-nil value.
9065
9066 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9067 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9068
9069 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9070 has been added.
9071
9072 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9073
9074 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9075
9076 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9077 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9078
9079 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9080 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9081
9082 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9083
9084 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9085 been added.
9086
9087 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9088 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9089
9090 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9091 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9092
9093 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9094
9095 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9096
9097 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9098
9099 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9100
9101 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9102 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9103 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9104
9105 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9106 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9107 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9108 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9109 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9110
9111 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9112 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9113 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9114 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9115
9116 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9117 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9118 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9119 mismatch.
9120
9121 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9122
9123 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9124 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9125
9126 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9127 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9128 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9129 removed from the label.
9130
9131 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9132 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9133
9134 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9135 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9136
9137 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9138 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9139 expressions.
9140
9141 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9142
9143 ** New/deleted modes and packages
9144
9145 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9146 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9147
9148 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9149 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9150 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9151
9152 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9153 changes with a special face.
9154
9155 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9156 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9157 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
9158 \f
9159 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9160
9161 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9162 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9163 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9164 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9165 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9166
9167 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9168 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9169 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9170
9171 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9172 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9173 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9174 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9175 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9176 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9177 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9178 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9179 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9180
9181 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9182 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9183 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9184 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9185 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9186 program.
9187
9188 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9189 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9190 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9191 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9192 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9193 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9194
9195 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9196 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9197 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9198 was not documented clearly before.
9199
9200 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9201 This includes Tetris and Snake.
9202 \f
9203 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9204
9205 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9206 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9207 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9208 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9209
9210 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9211 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9212 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9213
9214 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9215
9216 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9217 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9218
9219 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9220 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9221 integers.
9222
9223 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9224 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9225 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9226 file names and attributes are returned.
9227
9228 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9229 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
9230 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
9231 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9232 returns the result.
9233
9234 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9235 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9236
9237 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
9238
9239 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9240 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9241 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9242 optionally.
9243
9244 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9245 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9246
9247 **
9248 The new function process-running-child-p
9249 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9250 terminal to its own child process.
9251
9252 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9253 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9254 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9255 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9256
9257 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9258 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9259
9260 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
9261 :included is an alias for :visible.
9262
9263 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9264 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9265 to move or copy menu entries.
9266
9267 ** Multibyte editing changes
9268
9269 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9270 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9271 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9272 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9273 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9274 (setq char (sref str idx)
9275 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9276 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9277
9278 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9279 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9280 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9281
9282 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9283 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9284 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9285
9286 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
9287
9288 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9289 across the boundary.
9290
9291 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9292 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9293 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9294 contains 8-bit characters.
9295 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9296 contains invalid characters.
9297
9298 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9299 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9300 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9301 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9302 way.
9303
9304 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9305 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9306 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9307 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9308
9309 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9310 compose Thai characters in a string.
9311
9312 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9313 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9314 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9315 menus should always use the third argument.
9316
9317 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9318 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9319 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9320 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9321
9322 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9323 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9324 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9325 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9326
9327 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9328 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9329 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9330 echo area contents.
9331
9332 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
9333
9334 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
9335 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
9336 requested feature cannot be loaded.
9337
9338 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
9339 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
9340 means to clear out that attribute.
9341
9342 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
9343 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
9344
9345 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
9346 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
9347 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
9348 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
9349
9350 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
9351 the gap of the current buffer.
9352
9353 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
9354 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
9355 current buffer.
9356
9357 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
9358 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
9359 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
9360 it back in after any modifications have been made.
9361 \f
9362 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
9363
9364 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
9365 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
9366 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
9367 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
9368 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
9369
9370 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
9371 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
9372 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
9373 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
9374 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
9375
9376 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
9377 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
9378 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
9379
9380 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
9381 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
9382 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
9383 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
9384 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
9385 results.
9386
9387 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
9388 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
9389 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
9390 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
9391 \f
9392 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
9393
9394 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
9395 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
9396 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
9397 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
9398
9399 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
9400 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
9401 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
9402 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
9403 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
9404 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
9405 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
9406 region.
9407
9408 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
9409 selective undo.
9410
9411 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
9412 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
9413 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
9414 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
9415 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
9416
9417 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
9418 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
9419 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
9420 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
9421
9422 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
9423 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
9424 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
9425 something that most users not do.
9426
9427 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
9428 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
9429 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
9430 applications.
9431
9432 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
9433 pasting operations.
9434
9435 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
9436 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
9437 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
9438 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
9439 `ps-printer-name'.
9440
9441 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
9442 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
9443 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
9444 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
9445 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
9446 hits a new word.
9447
9448 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
9449 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
9450 to be confused by TeX commands.
9451
9452 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
9453 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
9454 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
9455 of various alternative replacements and actions.
9456
9457 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
9458 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
9459 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
9460 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
9461 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
9462
9463 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
9464 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
9465
9466 ** Changes in input method usage.
9467
9468 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
9469 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
9470 respectively.
9471
9472 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
9473
9474 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
9475 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
9476
9477 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
9478 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
9479
9480 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
9481
9482 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
9483
9484 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
9485 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
9486
9487 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
9488 given in the following case:
9489 o When you are using a complex input method.
9490 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
9491
9492 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
9493 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
9494 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
9495 setting it to t is helpful.
9496
9497 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
9498
9499 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
9500 keys:
9501 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
9502 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
9503 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
9504 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
9505 environment.
9506
9507 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
9508 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
9509 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
9510 get
9511
9512 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
9513
9514 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
9515
9516 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
9517 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
9518
9519 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
9520 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
9521 its owner and group.
9522
9523 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
9524 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
9525
9526 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
9527 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
9528
9529 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
9530 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
9531 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
9532 by the left edge of the rectangle.
9533
9534 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
9535 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
9536 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
9537 for writing keyboard macros.
9538
9539 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
9540 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
9541 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
9542 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
9543 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
9544 info.
9545
9546 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
9547
9548 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
9549 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
9550 contents only.
9551
9552 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
9553 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
9554 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
9555 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
9556
9557 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
9558 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
9559 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
9560
9561 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
9562 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
9563 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
9564 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
9565
9566 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
9567 failure if the command produces no output.
9568
9569 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
9570 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
9571 the mouse.
9572
9573 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
9574 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
9575 function and variable names.
9576
9577 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
9578 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
9579 file-coding-system-alist.
9580
9581 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
9582 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
9583 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
9584 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
9585 according to the current fontset.
9586
9587 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
9588
9589 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
9590 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
9591 nonascii-insert-offset.
9592
9593 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
9594 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
9595 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
9596 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
9597
9598 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
9599 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
9600
9601 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
9602 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
9603
9604 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
9605 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
9606 command keys.
9607
9608 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
9609 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
9610
9611 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
9612 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
9613 all variables that have documentation.
9614
9615 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
9616 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
9617 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
9618 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
9619 it should show; the default is 20.
9620
9621 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
9622 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
9623 of your input.
9624
9625 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
9626 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
9627 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
9628 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
9629 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
9630 Newly added options are included as well.
9631
9632 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
9633 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
9634 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
9635
9636 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
9637 Customize menu.
9638
9639 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
9640 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
9641
9642 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
9643 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
9644 invoked.
9645
9646 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
9647 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
9648 The default is 1.
9649
9650 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
9651 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
9652 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
9653 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
9654 sensibly.
9655
9656 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
9657
9658 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
9659 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
9660 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
9661
9662 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
9663 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
9664 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
9665 every night.
9666
9667 ** Desktop changes
9668
9669 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
9670 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
9671
9672 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
9673 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
9674
9675 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
9676 read and post multi-lingual articles.
9677
9678 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
9679 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
9680 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
9681 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
9682 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
9683 made invisible again.
9684
9685 ** Mail reading and sending changes
9686
9687 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
9688 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
9689 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
9690 toggle.
9691
9692 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
9693 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
9694 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
9695 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
9696 rmail-default-body-file.
9697
9698 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
9699 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
9700 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
9701
9702 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
9703 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
9704 is evaluated to insert the signature.
9705
9706 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
9707 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
9708 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
9709 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
9710 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
9711 especially interested in trying feedmail.
9712
9713 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
9714 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
9715 provided by feedmail are:
9716
9717 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
9718 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
9719 there is also a queue for draft messages
9720
9721 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
9722 be prompted for confirmation
9723
9724 **** does smart filling of address headers
9725
9726 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
9727 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
9728 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
9729
9730 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
9731 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
9732 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
9733 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
9734
9735 ** Dired changes
9736
9737 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
9738 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
9739
9740 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
9741 run Dired on the directory name at point.
9742
9743 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
9744 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
9745 for a specified regexp.
9746
9747 ** VC Changes
9748
9749 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
9750 conveniently.
9751
9752 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
9753 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
9754 Dired.
9755
9756 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
9757 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
9758 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
9759 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
9760
9761 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
9762 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
9763 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
9764 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
9765 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
9766
9767 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
9768 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
9769 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
9770 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
9771 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
9772
9773 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
9774 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
9775 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
9776 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
9777
9778 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
9779 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
9780 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
9781
9782 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
9783 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
9784 session to resolve them.
9785
9786 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
9787 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
9788 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
9789 uses as well).
9790
9791 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
9792 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
9793 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
9794 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
9795 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
9796 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
9797 using ediff.
9798
9799 ** Changes in Font Lock
9800
9801 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
9802 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
9803 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
9804 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
9805 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
9806
9807 ** Frame name display changes
9808
9809 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
9810 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
9811 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
9812 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
9813
9814 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
9815 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
9816 menu.
9817
9818 ** Comint (subshell) changes
9819
9820 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
9821 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
9822 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
9823
9824 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
9825
9826 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
9827 that is, the line after the last line you got.
9828 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
9829
9830 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
9831 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
9832 the following line.
9833
9834 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
9835 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
9836 previously sent input.
9837
9838 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
9839 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
9840 as the search string.
9841
9842 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
9843 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
9844
9845 ** C mode changes
9846
9847 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
9848 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
9849 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
9850 definition.
9851
9852 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
9853 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
9854 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
9855 style is still the default however.
9856
9857 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
9858
9859 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
9860 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
9861 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
9862
9863 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
9864 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
9865
9866 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
9867 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
9868
9869 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
9870 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
9871
9872 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
9873 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
9874
9875 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
9876 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
9877 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
9878 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
9879
9880 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
9881
9882 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
9883 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
9884 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
9885
9886 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
9887 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
9888 expanding dynamically.
9889
9890 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
9891 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
9892
9893 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
9894 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
9895 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
9896 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
9897
9898 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
9899
9900 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
9901
9902 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
9903 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
9904 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
9905 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
9906 against the first word in the title.
9907
9908 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
9909 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
9910 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
9911 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
9912 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
9913 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
9914
9915 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
9916 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
9917 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
9918 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
9919
9920 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
9921
9922 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
9923 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
9924 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
9925 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
9926 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
9927 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
9928
9929 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
9930 Editing group once the package is loaded.
9931
9932 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
9933 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
9934 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
9935
9936 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
9937 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
9938
9939 ** Ispell changes.
9940
9941 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
9942 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
9943 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
9944
9945 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
9946 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
9947 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
9948 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
9949 include:
9950
9951 o URLs are automatically skipped
9952 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
9953
9954 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
9955
9956 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9957
9958 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
9959 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
9960 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
9961 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
9962
9963 *** New recursive parser.
9964
9965 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
9966 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
9967 recursive parser scans the individual files.
9968
9969 *** Parsing only part of a document.
9970
9971 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
9972 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
9973 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
9974
9975 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
9976
9977 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
9978
9979 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
9980
9981 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
9982
9983 *** Using multiple selection buffers
9984
9985 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
9986 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
9987
9988 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
9989
9990 *** References to external documents.
9991
9992 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
9993 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
9994 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
9995 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
9996 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
9997 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
9998 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
9999
10000 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10001
10002 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
10003 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10004
10005 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10006 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10007
10008 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10009
10010 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10011 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10012
10013 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10014
10015 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10016 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10017 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10018 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10019 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10020 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10021 more.
10022
10023 *** Support for the varioref package
10024
10025 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10026
10027 *** New hooks
10028
10029 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10030 and citations are created. These hooks are
10031 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10032 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
10033
10034 *** Citations outside LaTeX
10035
10036 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10037 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10038
10039 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
10040
10041 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10042 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10043 fontified, use
10044
10045 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10046
10047 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10048 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10049 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10050 directories that contain the same file name.
10051
10052 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10053 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10054 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10055 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10056 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10057 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10058 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10059 directory.
10060
10061 ** New modes and packages
10062
10063 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10064 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10065 it, but some do not.
10066
10067 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10068 code.
10069
10070 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10071 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10072 around in a buffer.
10073
10074 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10075
10076 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10077 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10078 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10079 established system of notation similar to Chess.
10080
10081 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10082 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10083 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10084
10085 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10086 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10087 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10088 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10089 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10090 the like.
10091
10092 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10093 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10094
10095 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10096 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10097 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10098 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10099
10100 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10101
10102 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10103 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10104 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10105 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10106 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10107 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10108 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10109 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10110 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10111 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10112 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10113
10114 Platform-specific modes:
10115
10116 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10117 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10118 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10119 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10120 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10121 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10122 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10123 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10124 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
10125 \f
10126 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10127
10128 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10129 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10130 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10131 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10132
10133 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10134 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10135 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10136
10137 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10138 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10139 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10140 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10141
10142 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10143 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10144 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10145 environment.
10146
10147 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10148 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10149 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10150 current input method for reading this one event.
10151
10152 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10153 now control whether to output certain characters as
10154 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10155 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10156 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10157 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
10158 \f
10159 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10160
10161 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10162 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10163
10164 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10165 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10166 always increases point by 1.
10167
10168 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10169 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10170
10171 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10172
10173 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10174 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10175 default value changed. For example,
10176
10177 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10178 :type 'integer
10179 :group 'foo
10180 :version "20.3")
10181
10182 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10183 :version "20.3")
10184
10185 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10186 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10187 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10188 `:version' in the top level group.
10189
10190 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10191
10192 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10193 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10194
10195 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10196 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10197 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10198 to themselves.
10199
10200 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10201 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10202 values whatever.
10203
10204 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
10205 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10206 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10207
10208 ** Frame-local variables.
10209
10210 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10211 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10212 local bindings for that variable.
10213
10214 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10215 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10216 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10217 parameter name.
10218
10219 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10220 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10221 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10222 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10223
10224 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10225 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10226 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10227 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10228
10229 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10230 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10231 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10232 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10233 See the documentation in sregex.el.
10234
10235 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10236 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10237 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10238 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10239
10240 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10241 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10242
10243 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10244 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10245 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10246
10247 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10248 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10249 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10250 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10251
10252 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10253 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10254 empty input.
10255
10256 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10257 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10258 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10259 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10260 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10261
10262 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10263 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10264 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10265 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10266
10267 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10268 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10269 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10270 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10271 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10272
10273 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10274 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10275 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10276 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10277
10278 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10279 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10280 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10281
10282 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10283 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10284 was directed to display this buffer.
10285
10286 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10287 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10288 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10289 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10290 set-window-configuration.
10291
10292 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10293 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10294 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10295 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10296
10297 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10298 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10299 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10300
10301 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10302 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10303 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10304
10305 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10306 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10307
10308 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10309 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10310
10311 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10312 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10313 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10314
10315 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10316 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10317 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10318 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10319
10320 ** Menu changes
10321
10322 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10323 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10324 better supported.
10325
10326 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10327 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10328 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10329 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10330 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
10331
10332 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
10333
10334 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
10335 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
10336 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
10337 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
10338
10339 The format is:
10340 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
10341 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
10342 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
10343 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
10344 The supported properties include
10345
10346 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10347 item is enabled.
10348 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10349 item should appear in the menu.
10350 :filter FILTER-FN
10351 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
10352 which will be REAL-BINDING.
10353 It should return a binding to use instead.
10354 :keys DESCRIPTION
10355 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
10356 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
10357 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
10358 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
10359 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
10360 keyboard binding.
10361 :key-sequence nil
10362 This means that the command normally has no
10363 keyboard equivalent.
10364 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
10365 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
10366 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
10367 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
10368 value says whether this button is currently selected.
10369
10370 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
10371 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
10372
10373 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
10374
10375 ** New event types
10376
10377 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
10378 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
10379 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
10380 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
10381
10382 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
10383
10384 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10385 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
10386 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
10387 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
10388 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
10389 forward, away from the user.
10390
10391 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10392
10393 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
10394 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
10395 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
10396 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
10397 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
10398
10399 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
10400
10401 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10402 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
10403 that were dragged and dropped.
10404
10405 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10406
10407 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
10408
10409 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
10410 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
10411 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
10412
10413 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
10414 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
10415 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
10416
10417 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
10418 in Emacs 19 and before.
10419
10420 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
10421 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
10422
10423 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
10424 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
10425 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
10426 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
10427
10428 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
10429 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
10430 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
10431 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
10432 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
10433
10434 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
10435 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
10436 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
10437 consistent with the new representation.
10438
10439 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
10440 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
10441 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
10442 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10443
10444 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
10445 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
10446 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
10447
10448 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
10449 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
10450 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10451
10452 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
10453 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
10454 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
10455
10456 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10457 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
10458
10459 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10460 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
10461
10462 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
10463 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
10464 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
10465 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
10466
10467 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
10468 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
10469
10470 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
10471 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
10472 buffer or string being searched.
10473
10474 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
10475 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
10476 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
10477 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
10478 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
10479 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
10480 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
10481
10482 *** Structure of coding system changed.
10483
10484 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
10485 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
10486 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
10487 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
10488 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
10489 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
10490 define-coding-system-alias.
10491
10492 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
10493 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
10494 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
10495 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
10496 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
10497 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
10498 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
10499 `iso-8859-1'.
10500
10501 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
10502 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
10503 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
10504 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
10505
10506 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
10507 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
10508 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
10509 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
10510
10511 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
10512 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
10513 This function requires a user interaction.
10514
10515 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
10516 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
10517 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
10518 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
10519 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
10520 select-safe-coding-system.
10521
10522 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
10523 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
10524 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
10525 was done.
10526
10527 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
10528 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
10529 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
10530
10531 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
10532 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
10533 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
10534 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
10535
10536 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
10537 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
10538 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
10539 converted.
10540
10541 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
10542 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
10543
10544 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
10545 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
10546 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
10547 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
10548 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
10549 range of characters.
10550
10551 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
10552 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
10553
10554 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
10555 in the current buffer at position POS.
10556
10557 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
10558 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
10559 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
10560 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
10561 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
10562 binding input-method-function to nil.
10563
10564 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
10565 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
10566 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
10567 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
10568 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
10569
10570 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
10571 subsequent events of a key sequence.
10572
10573 *** You can customize any language environment by using
10574 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
10575
10576 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
10577 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
10578 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
10579 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
10580 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
10581 \f
10582 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
10583
10584 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
10585 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
10586 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
10587 tree structure.
10588
10589 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
10590 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
10591
10592 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
10593 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
10594 in your .emacs file.)
10595
10596 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
10597 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
10598
10599 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
10600 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
10601
10602 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
10603 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
10604 kills the region.
10605
10606 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
10607 delete the character before point, as usual.
10608
10609 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
10610 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
10611 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
10612
10613 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
10614 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
10615 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
10616 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
10617 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
10618 past.)
10619
10620 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
10621 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
10622 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
10623 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
10624 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
10625
10626 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
10627 and is an alias for it.
10628
10629 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
10630 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
10631
10632 ** Scrolling changes
10633
10634 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
10635 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
10636
10637 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
10638 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
10639 where it started.
10640
10641 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
10642 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
10643 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
10644 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
10645
10646 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
10647 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
10648 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
10649 recenters the window.
10650
10651 ** International character set support (MULE)
10652
10653 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
10654 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
10655 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
10656 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
10657 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
10658 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
10659
10660 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
10661 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
10662 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
10663 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
10664 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
10665
10666 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
10667 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
10668 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
10669 language, to make it possible to type them.
10670
10671 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
10672 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
10673
10674 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
10675 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
10676
10677 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
10678
10679 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
10680
10681 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
10682 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
10683 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
10684 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
10685 characters for their work until they want to change.
10686
10687 *** Input methods
10688
10689 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
10690 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
10691 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
10692 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
10693 support several input methods.
10694
10695 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
10696 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
10697 work.
10698
10699 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
10700 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
10701 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
10702 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
10703 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
10704 letter.
10705
10706 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
10707 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
10708 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
10709 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
10710 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
10711
10712 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
10713 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
10714 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
10715 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
10716
10717 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
10718 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
10719 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
10720 the first guess is wrong.
10721
10722 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
10723 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
10724
10725 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
10726 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
10727 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
10728 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
10729
10730 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
10731 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
10732 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
10733 translate automatically to and from either one.
10734
10735 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
10736
10737 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
10738 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
10739 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
10740 what you want.
10741
10742 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
10743 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
10744 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
10745 multibyte characters in that buffer.
10746
10747 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
10748 character conversion as well.
10749
10750 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
10751
10752 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
10753 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
10754 requires using many fonts.
10755
10756 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
10757 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
10758
10759 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
10760 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
10761 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
10762 you would use a font.
10763
10764 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
10765 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
10766 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
10767
10768 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
10769 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
10770 characters).
10771
10772 *** Defining fontsets.
10773
10774 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
10775 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
10776 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
10777
10778 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
10779 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
10780 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
10781 standard fontset are created automatically.
10782
10783 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
10784 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
10785 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
10786 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
10787 name is `fontset-startup'.
10788
10789 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
10790 The resource value should have this form:
10791 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
10792 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
10793 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
10794 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
10795 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
10796 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
10797 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
10798 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
10799 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
10800
10801 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
10802 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
10803 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
10804
10805 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
10806 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
10807 following resource,
10808 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
10809 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
10810 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
10811 Here is the substitution rule:
10812 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
10813 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
10814 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
10815 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
10816 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
10817
10818 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
10819 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
10820 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
10821
10822 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
10823 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
10824 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
10825 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
10826 fontsets.
10827
10828 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
10829 defaults for a particular choice of language.
10830
10831 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
10832 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
10833 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
10834 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
10835 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
10836 system for new files that you create.
10837
10838 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
10839 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
10840 whole Emacs session.
10841
10842 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
10843 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
10844 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
10845
10846 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
10847 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
10848 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
10849 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
10850 coding systems that Emacs supports.
10851
10852 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
10853 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
10854 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
10855 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
10856 is used for *the immediately following command*.
10857
10858 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
10859 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
10860
10861 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
10862 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
10863
10864 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
10865 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
10866
10867 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
10868 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
10869 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
10870 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
10871 of the file.
10872
10873 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
10874 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
10875 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
10876 translated into that character code.
10877
10878 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
10879 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
10880
10881 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
10882
10883 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
10884 the coding system for keyboard input.
10885
10886 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
10887 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
10888 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
10889
10890 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
10891
10892 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
10893 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
10894 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
10895 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
10896 designed to work with terminals.
10897
10898 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
10899 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
10900 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
10901 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
10902 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
10903 in the corresponding buffer.
10904
10905 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
10906
10907 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
10908 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
10909 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
10910
10911 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
10912 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
10913 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
10914 want to use.
10915
10916 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
10917 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
10918
10919 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
10920 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
10921 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
10922 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
10923
10924 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
10925 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
10926 related information.
10927
10928 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
10929 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
10930 scripts.
10931
10932 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
10933 information about the support for a particular language.
10934 You specify the language as an argument.
10935
10936 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
10937 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
10938 first dash.
10939
10940 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
10941 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
10942 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
10943 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
10944
10945 A alternativnyj (Russian)
10946 B big5 (Chinese)
10947 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
10948 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
10949 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
10950 E euc-japan (Japanese)
10951 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10952 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
10953 K euc-korea (Korean)
10954 R koi8 (Russian)
10955 Q tibetan
10956 S shift_jis (Japanese)
10957 T lao
10958 T tis620 (Thai)
10959 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
10960 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10961 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
10962 v viqr (Vietnamese)
10963 z hz (Chinese)
10964
10965 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
10966 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
10967 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
10968 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
10969
10970 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
10971 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
10972
10973 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
10974 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
10975 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
10976 Rmail files themselves.
10977
10978 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
10979 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
10980
10981 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
10982 for sending mail:
10983
10984 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
10985 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
10986 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
10987 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
10988 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
10989
10990 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
10991 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
10992 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
10993 translations.
10994
10995 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
10996 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
10997 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
10998 without any conversion.
10999
11000 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11001 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11002 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11003 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11004
11005 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11006 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11007
11008 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11009 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11010
11011 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11012 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11013
11014 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11015 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11016 in the buffer before point.
11017
11018 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11019 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11020 you are using.
11021
11022 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11023 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11024
11025 ** File locking works with NFS now.
11026
11027 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11028 in the same directory as FILENAME.
11029
11030 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11031 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11032 can become a bottleneck.
11033
11034 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11035 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11036 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11037 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11038 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11039 so useful that the change is worth while.
11040
11041 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11042 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11043 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11044 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11045
11046 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11047 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11048 show-paren-mode.
11049
11050 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11051 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11052 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11053
11054 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11055 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11056 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11057
11058 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11059 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11060 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11061
11062 ** Changes in View mode.
11063
11064 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11065 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11066
11067 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11068 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11069
11070 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11071 previous state.
11072
11073 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11074 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11075
11076 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11077 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11078 not just the selected window.
11079
11080 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11081 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11082 turns View mode on or off.
11083
11084 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11085 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11086 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11087
11088 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11089 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11090
11091 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11092 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11093 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11094 which version to compare with.
11095
11096 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11097 blocks if a match is inside the block.
11098
11099 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11100 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11101 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11102 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11103
11104 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11105 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11106 blocks, all of them or none.
11107
11108 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11109 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11110 confirmation first.
11111
11112 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11113 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11114 However, the mode will not be changed if
11115 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11116 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11117 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11118 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11119
11120 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11121
11122 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11123 these commands do not change the major mode.
11124
11125 ** M-x occur changes.
11126
11127 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11128 it performs a case-sensitive search.
11129
11130 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11131 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11132 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11133
11134 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11135 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11136 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11137 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11138 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11139
11140 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11141 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11142 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11143 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11144
11145 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11146 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11147 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11148
11149 ** Outline mode changes.
11150
11151 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11152
11153 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11154
11155 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11156 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11157 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11158 was already active.
11159
11160 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11161 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11162 get confused by it.
11163
11164 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11165 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11166
11167 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11168
11169 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11170 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11171 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11172 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11173
11174 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11175 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11176 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11177
11178 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11179 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11180 values.
11181
11182 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11183 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11184 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11185 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11186
11187 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11188 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11189 can be. The default value is 30.
11190
11191 ** Changes in Mail mode.
11192
11193 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11194 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11195 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11196 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11197 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11198 behavior.
11199
11200 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11201 compose-mail-other-frame.
11202
11203 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11204 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11205 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11206 buffer that shows the original message.
11207
11208 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11209 with separator lines around the contents.
11210
11211 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11212 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11213 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11214 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11215
11216 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
11217
11218 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11219 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11220 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11221 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11222
11223 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11224 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11225 /etc/passwd.
11226
11227 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11228 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11229 /etc/passwd.
11230
11231 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11232 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11233 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11234 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11235
11236 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11237 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11238 be taken to be magic.
11239
11240 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11241 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11242 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11243
11244 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11245 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11246
11247 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11248 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11249
11250 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11251
11252 new key dired.el binding old key
11253 ------- ---------------- -------
11254 * c dired-change-marks c
11255 * m dired-mark m
11256 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11257 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11258 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11259 * u dired-unmark u
11260 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
11261 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
11262 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11263 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11264 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11265 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11266
11267 ** Rmail changes.
11268
11269 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11270 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11271 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11272 each time you run it.
11273
11274 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11275 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11276
11277 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11278 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11279 means to move in the opposite direction.
11280
11281 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11282 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11283
11284 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11285 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11286 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11287 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11288 for output.
11289
11290 ** Gnus changes.
11291
11292 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11293
11294 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11295 Gnus.
11296
11297 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11298 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11299
11300 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11301 article mode line.
11302
11303 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11304
11305 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11306
11307 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11308
11309 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11310 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11311 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11312
11313 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11314
11315 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11316
11317 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11318 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11319
11320 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11321 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11322 used to pick articles.
11323
11324 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11325 another have been added.
11326
11327 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11328
11329 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11330 generating lines in buffers.
11331
11332 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
11333 `C-M-_'.
11334
11335 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
11336
11337 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
11338
11339 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
11340
11341 *** Scores can be decayed.
11342
11343 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
11344
11345 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
11346 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
11347
11348 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
11349 the native server.
11350
11351 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
11352
11353 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
11354 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
11355
11356 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
11357
11358 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
11359 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
11360
11361 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
11362 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
11363
11364 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
11365 a group.
11366
11367 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
11368 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
11369
11370 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
11371
11372 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
11373
11374 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
11375
11376 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
11377
11378 Use the `Y c' command.
11379
11380 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
11381
11382 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
11383
11384 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
11385
11386 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
11387 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
11388
11389 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
11390
11391 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
11392
11393 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
11394 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
11395
11396 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
11397
11398 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
11399 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
11400 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
11401 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
11402 this issue.)
11403
11404 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
11405 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
11406 particular news group. This can be done by:
11407
11408 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
11409
11410 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
11411 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
11412 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
11413 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
11414 for reading and posting).
11415
11416 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
11417 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
11418 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
11419 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
11420 there.
11421
11422 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
11423 default. Here are some of these default settings:
11424
11425 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
11426 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
11427 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
11428 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
11429 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
11430
11431 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
11432 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
11433
11434 ** CC mode changes.
11435
11436 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
11437 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
11438 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
11439 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
11440 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
11441 loaded.
11442
11443 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
11444 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
11445 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
11446 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
11447 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
11448 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
11449
11450 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
11451 of the current buffer.
11452
11453 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
11454 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
11455 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
11456
11457 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
11458 style that the Python developers like.
11459
11460 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
11461 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
11462 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
11463
11464 ** VC Changes [new]
11465
11466 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
11467 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
11468 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
11469
11470 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
11471 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
11472 developers.
11473
11474 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
11475 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
11476
11477 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
11478 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
11479 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
11480 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
11481
11482 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
11483 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
11484
11485 ** Calendar changes.
11486
11487 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
11488 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
11489 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
11490 following/previous years.
11491
11492 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
11493 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
11494 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
11495 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
11496 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
11497 supposed attribute of God.
11498
11499 ** ps-print changes
11500
11501 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
11502 layout.
11503
11504 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
11505
11506 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
11507 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
11508 printer system has this behavior, set variable
11509 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
11510
11511 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
11512 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
11513 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
11514
11515 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
11516 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
11517
11518 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
11519 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
11520 printing for your printer.
11521
11522 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
11523 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
11524
11525 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
11526 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
11527
11528 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
11529 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
11530 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
11531 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
11532 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
11533 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
11534 The default value is nil.
11535
11536 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
11537 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
11538
11539 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
11540 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
11541 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
11542 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
11543 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
11544 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
11545 color). The default is 0 ("black").
11546
11547 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
11548 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
11549
11550 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
11551 The default is 0 ("black").
11552
11553 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
11554 The default is 0 ("black").
11555
11556 border-width Specify the border width.
11557 The default is 0.4.
11558
11559 Any other property is ignored.
11560
11561 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
11562 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
11563 documentation).
11564
11565 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
11566 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
11567 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
11568 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
11569 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
11570 controlling headers.
11571
11572 *** Color management (subgroup)
11573
11574 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
11575 color.
11576
11577 *** Face Management (subgroup)
11578
11579 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
11580 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
11581 background should be used. Valid values are:
11582
11583 t always use face background color.
11584 nil never use face background color.
11585 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
11586
11587 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
11588
11589 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
11590 sheet of paper.
11591
11592 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
11593 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
11594
11595 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
11596 each page.
11597
11598 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
11599 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
11600 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
11601
11602 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
11603 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
11604 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
11605
11606 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
11607 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
11608 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
11609
11610 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
11611 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
11612 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
11613
11614 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
11615 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
11616 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
11617
11618 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
11619
11620 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
11621
11622 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
11623 RGB color.
11624
11625 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
11626 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
11627 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
11628
11629 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
11630 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11631 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11632 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11633 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11634 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
11635 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
11636 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
11637 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11638 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11639 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11640 10 + 10 +
11641 11 + 11 +
11642 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11643 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11644 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
11645 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
11646 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
11647 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11648 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11649 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11650 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
11651 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
11652 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
11653 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
11654 22 + 22 +
11655 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11656
11657 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
11658
11659
11660 *** Printer management (subgroup)
11661
11662 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
11663 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
11664 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
11665 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
11666 to "-P".
11667
11668 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
11669 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
11670 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
11671
11672 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
11673 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
11674 do so.
11675
11676 *** Page settings (subgroup)
11677
11678 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
11679 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
11680 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
11681 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
11682 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
11683 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
11684 `setpagedevice'.
11685
11686 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
11687 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
11688 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
11689
11690 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
11691 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
11692 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
11693 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
11694 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
11695 its TO, are ignored.
11696
11697 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
11698 pages. Valid values are:
11699
11700 nil print all pages.
11701
11702 `even-page' print only even pages.
11703
11704 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
11705
11706 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
11707 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11708 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
11709 print only the even sheet of paper.
11710
11711 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
11712 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11713 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
11714 only the odd sheet of paper.
11715
11716 Any other value is treated as nil.
11717
11718 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
11719 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
11720 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
11721
11722 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
11723
11724 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
11725 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
11726
11727 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
11728 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11729 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
11730 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11731 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11732 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11733 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11734
11735 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
11736 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11737 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
11738 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
11739 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
11740 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
11741 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
11742
11743 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
11744
11745 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
11746 messages should be sent.
11747
11748 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
11749 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
11750 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
11751
11752 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
11753
11754 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
11755 points for line numbers.
11756
11757 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
11758 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
11759
11760 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
11761 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
11762 to 2, the printing will look like:
11763
11764 1 one line
11765 one line
11766 3 one line
11767 one line
11768 5 one line
11769 one line
11770 ...
11771
11772 Valid values are:
11773
11774 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
11775 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
11776 is used.
11777
11778 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
11779 zebra stripe is to be printed.
11780
11781 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
11782
11783 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
11784 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
11785 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
11786 3, the output will look like:
11787
11788 one line
11789 one line
11790 3 one line
11791 one line
11792 one line
11793 6 one line
11794 one line
11795 one line
11796 9 one line
11797 one line
11798 ...
11799
11800 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
11801 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
11802
11803 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
11804 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11805 `ps-font-size').
11806
11807 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
11808 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11809 `ps-font-size').
11810
11811 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
11812
11813 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
11814 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
11815
11816 ** hideshow changes.
11817
11818 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
11819 C++, ; for lisp).
11820
11821 *** Support for java-mode added.
11822
11823 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
11824 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
11825
11826 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
11827 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
11828 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
11829
11830 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
11831 robust and a lot faster.
11832
11833 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
11834
11835 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
11836 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
11837 documentation for more details.
11838
11839 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
11840
11841 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
11842 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
11843 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
11844 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
11845 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
11846
11847 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
11848 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
11849 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
11850 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
11851
11852 ** Font Lock mode
11853
11854 *** Custom support
11855
11856 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
11857 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
11858 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
11859 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
11860 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
11861 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
11862
11863 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
11864
11865 *** Maximum decoration
11866
11867 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
11868 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
11869 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
11870 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
11871 to get the old behavior.
11872
11873 *** New support
11874
11875 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
11876
11877 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
11878 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
11879
11880 *** Configurable support
11881
11882 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
11883 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
11884 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
11885 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
11886 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
11887 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
11888 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
11889
11890 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
11891 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
11892 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
11893
11894 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
11895
11896 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
11897 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
11898 for any mode.
11899
11900 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
11901
11902 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
11903
11904 in your ~/.emacs.
11905
11906 *** New faces
11907
11908 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
11909 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
11910 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
11911 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
11912
11913 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
11914
11915 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
11916 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
11917 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
11918
11919 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
11920
11921 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
11922 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
11923 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
11924 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
11925 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
11926 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
11927 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
11928
11929 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
11930 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
11931 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
11932 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
11933 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
11934 the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
11935
11936 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
11937
11938 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
11939 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
11940 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
11941 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
11942
11943 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
11944 settings.
11945
11946 ** Ada mode changes.
11947
11948 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
11949 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
11950 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
11951 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
11952 stubs.
11953
11954 *** There are two new commands:
11955 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
11956 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
11957
11958 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
11959 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
11960 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
11961
11962 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
11963 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
11964 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
11965
11966 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
11967 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
11968 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
11969 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
11970
11971 ** Scheme mode changes.
11972
11973 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
11974 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
11975 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
11976 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
11977 have any effect.
11978
11979 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
11980 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
11981 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
11982 variables as buffer-local variables.
11983
11984 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
11985 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
11986
11987 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
11988
11989 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
11990 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
11991 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
11992 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
11993
11994 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
11995 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
11996 buffer in Emacs.
11997
11998 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
11999 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12000 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12001 option takes precedence.
12002
12003 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12004 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12005 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12006
12007 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12008 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12009 the current defun.
12010
12011 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12012 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12013
12014 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12015 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12016 necessary).
12017
12018 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12019 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12020 these register values no longer become completely useless.
12021 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12022 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12023 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12024
12025 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12026 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12027 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12028 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12029
12030 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12031 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12032 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12033 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12034 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12035
12036 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12037 since it applies only to the current frame.
12038
12039 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12040 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12041 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12042
12043 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12044 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12045 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12046 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12047 instead of just the file you are editing.
12048
12049 ** RefTeX mode
12050
12051 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12052 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12053 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12054 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12055 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12056
12057 C-c ( reftex-label
12058 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12059 knows which kind of label is needed.
12060
12061 C-c ) reftex-reference
12062 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12063 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12064
12065 C-c [ reftex-citation
12066 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12067 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12068
12069 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12070 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12071
12072 C-c = reftex-toc
12073 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12074 can quickly jump to every section.
12075
12076 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12077 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12078 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12079 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12080 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12081
12082 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12083
12084 *** Info documentation is now available.
12085
12086 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12087 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12088
12089 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12090 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12091
12092 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12093 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12094
12095 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12096 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12097 appropriate functions.
12098
12099 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
12100 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
12101
12102 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12103 been cleaned.
12104
12105 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12106 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12107
12108 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12109 shall be delimited.
12110
12111 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12112 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12113 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12114
12115 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12116 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12117 prefixed with `ALT'.
12118
12119 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12120 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12121 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12122 documentation).
12123
12124 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12125 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12126 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12127
12128 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12129 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12130
12131 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12132 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12133 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12134
12135 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12136
12137 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12138
12139 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12140 from alien sources.
12141
12142 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12143 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12144 crossref entries.
12145
12146 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12147 region.
12148
12149 *** Added support for imenu.
12150
12151 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12152 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12153 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12154 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12155
12156 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12157 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12158
12159 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12160
12161 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12162
12163 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12164 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12165 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12166 as an argument.
12167
12168 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12169 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12170
12171 ** browse-url changes
12172
12173 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12174 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12175 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12176 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12177 customization variables.
12178
12179 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12180
12181 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12182 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12183 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12184
12185 ** Changes in Ediff
12186
12187 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12188 pops up the Info file for this command.
12189
12190 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12191 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12192 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12193 directories).
12194
12195 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12196 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12197 files in the same directory.
12198
12199 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12200 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12201 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12202
12203 ** Changes in Viper
12204
12205 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12206 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12207 instead of vip-.
12208 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12209 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12210 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12211 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12212 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12213 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12214 color when Viper is in insert state.
12215 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12216 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12217 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12218
12219 ** Etags changes.
12220
12221 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12222 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12223 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12224 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12225 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12226
12227 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12228
12229 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12230 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12231
12232 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12233 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12234 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12235
12236 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12237 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12238 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12239 methods and protocols.
12240
12241 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12242 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12243 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12244 paragraph name.
12245
12246 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12247 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12248 at least M times and as many as N times.
12249
12250 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12251 in files has changed slightly.
12252
12253 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12254 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12255 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12256 with old time-stamp-format values.
12257
12258 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12259 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12260 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12261 reasons.
12262
12263 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12264 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12265 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12266 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12267 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12268 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12269
12270 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12271 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12272 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12273
12274 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12275 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12276 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12277 recommended now will continue to work then.
12278
12279 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12280 details.
12281
12282 ** There are some additional major modes:
12283
12284 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12285 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12286 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12287
12288 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12289 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12290 into Emacs.
12291
12292 ** New Lisp packages include:
12293
12294 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12295
12296 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12297 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12298
12299 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12300
12301 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12302 in shell buffers.
12303
12304 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12305 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12306 and `elint-defun'.
12307
12308 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12309 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12310 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12311 strings or comments.
12312
12313 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12314 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12315 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12316 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12317 at these points.
12318
12319 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12320 can visit them by short forms of their names.
12321
12322 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12323 Emacs Lisp function at point.
12324
12325 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12326
12327 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12328 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12329
12330 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
12331
12332 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
12333
12334 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
12335
12336 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
12337 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
12338
12339 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
12340 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
12341 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
12342 original place after inserting the copy.
12343
12344 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
12345 on the buffer.
12346
12347 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
12348 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
12349 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
12350
12351 Enable mouse-drag with:
12352 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
12353 -or-
12354 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
12355
12356 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
12357 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
12358
12359 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
12360 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
12361
12362 *** ogonek
12363
12364 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
12365 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
12366 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
12367 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
12368 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
12369 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
12370 instance) and vice versa.
12371
12372 To use this package load it using
12373 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
12374 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
12375 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
12376 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
12377 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
12378 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
12379
12380 *** Interface to ph.
12381
12382 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
12383
12384 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
12385 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
12386 these servers.
12387
12388 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
12389
12390 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
12391 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
12392 while the real cursor does not move.
12393
12394 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
12395 for visiting your favorite web sites.
12396
12397 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
12398 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
12399
12400 ** movemail change
12401
12402 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
12403 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
12404 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
12405 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
12406
12407 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
12408 \f
12409 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
12410
12411 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
12412
12413 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
12414 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
12415 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
12416 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
12417 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
12418
12419 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
12420 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
12421 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
12422 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
12423 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
12424 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
12425 \f
12426 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
12427
12428 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
12429 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
12430 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
12431 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
12432
12433 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
12434 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
12435
12436 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
12437 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
12438 "win".
12439
12440 ** Basic Lisp changes
12441
12442 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
12443 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
12444
12445 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
12446 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
12447 or by the user.
12448
12449 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
12450
12451 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
12452
12453 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
12454 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
12455
12456 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
12457 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
12458 its argument.
12459
12460 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
12461
12462 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
12463
12464 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
12465
12466 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
12467 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
12468 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
12469 `format' function.
12470
12471 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
12472 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
12473 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
12474
12475 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
12476 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
12477 adding one of these suffixes.
12478
12479 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
12480 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
12481 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
12482
12483 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
12484 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
12485
12486 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
12487
12488 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
12489 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
12490
12491 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
12492 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
12493
12494 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
12495
12496 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
12497 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
12498
12499 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
12500 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
12501 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
12502 works using `save-current-buffer'.
12503
12504 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
12505 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
12506 of the last form.
12507
12508 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
12509 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
12510 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
12511 as the last form.
12512
12513 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
12514 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
12515 matches.
12516
12517 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
12518
12519 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
12520 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
12521 Then it returns that string.
12522
12523 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
12524
12525 (with-output-to-string
12526 (princ "The buffer is ")
12527 (princ (buffer-name)))
12528
12529 returns "The buffer is foo".
12530
12531 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
12532 is non-nil.
12533
12534 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
12535 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
12536 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
12537
12538 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
12539 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
12540
12541 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
12542 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
12543 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
12544 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
12545 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
12546 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
12547
12548 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
12549 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
12550 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
12551 characters".
12552
12553 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
12554 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
12555 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
12556 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
12557 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
12558
12559 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
12560 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
12561 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
12562 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
12563
12564 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
12565 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
12566
12567 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
12568
12569 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
12570 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
12571 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
12572 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
12573 guaranteed.
12574
12575 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
12576 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
12577 character).
12578
12579 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
12580
12581 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
12582 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
12583 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
12584 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
12585 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
12586
12587 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
12588
12589 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
12590 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
12591 more than the number of characters.
12592
12593 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
12594 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
12595 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
12596 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
12597 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
12598 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
12599
12600 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
12601 and returns a string containing those characters.
12602
12603 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
12604 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
12605 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
12606 character, sref signals an error.
12607
12608 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
12609 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
12610 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12611
12612 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
12613 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
12614 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12615
12616 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
12617 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
12618 to a vector of the characters in it.
12619
12620 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
12621 of a string. You call it as follows:
12622
12623 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
12624
12625 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
12626 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
12627 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
12628 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
12629 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
12630
12631 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
12632 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12633
12634 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
12635 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12636
12637 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
12638 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
12639 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
12640 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
12641
12642 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
12643
12644 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
12645
12646 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
12647 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
12648 are not included in the resulting value.
12649
12650 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
12651 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
12652 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
12653 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
12654
12655 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
12656 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
12657 character extends across that column), then the padding character
12658 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
12659 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
12660 column START-COLUMN.
12661
12662 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
12663 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
12664 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
12665 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
12666 changed text, before the change.
12667
12668 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
12669 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
12670 one character set for each script, not for each language.
12671
12672 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
12673
12674 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
12675
12676 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
12677 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
12678
12679 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
12680 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
12681 which identify the character within that character set.
12682
12683 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
12684 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
12685 opposite of split-char.
12686
12687 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
12688 of all the characters between BEG and END.
12689
12690 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
12691 of all the characters in a string.
12692
12693 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
12694 and specifying coding systems.
12695
12696 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
12697 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
12698 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
12699 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
12700 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
12701 as what to do about code conversion.)
12702
12703 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
12704 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
12705
12706 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12707 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12708 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
12709
12710 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12711 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
12712 to match against a file name.
12713
12714 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12715 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12716 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12717 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12718 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12719 specifies the coding system for encoding.
12720
12721 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12722 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12723
12724 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
12725 the coding system to use for network sockets.
12726
12727 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12728 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
12729 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
12730 service names.
12731
12732 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12733 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12734 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12735 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12736 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12737 specifies the coding system for encoding.
12738
12739 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12740 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12741
12742 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12743 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12744 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
12745 start the subprocess.
12746
12747 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
12748 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
12749 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
12750 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
12751 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
12752
12753 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
12754 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
12755 subprocess.
12756
12757 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
12758 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
12759 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
12760 connection permanently or until overridden.
12761
12762 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
12763 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
12764 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
12765 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
12766 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
12767 system for one operation at a time.
12768
12769 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
12770 files, subprocesses or network connections.
12771
12772 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
12773 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
12774 The value is a cons cell,
12775 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
12776 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
12777 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
12778 input to the subprocess.
12779
12780 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
12781 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
12782
12783 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
12784 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
12785 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
12786
12787 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
12788 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
12789 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
12790 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
12791 customization.
12792
12793 Thus, instead of writing
12794
12795 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
12796 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
12797
12798 you would now write this:
12799
12800 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
12801 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
12802 :type 'boolean
12803 :group foo)
12804
12805 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
12806 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
12807 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
12808 for a description of them.
12809
12810 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
12811 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
12812
12813 (defgroup ispell nil
12814 "Spell checking using Ispell."
12815 :group 'processes)
12816
12817 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
12818 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
12819 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
12820 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
12821 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
12822
12823 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
12824 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
12825 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
12826 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
12827 first-level subgroups.
12828
12829 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
12830
12831 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
12832 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
12833
12834 ** easy-mmode
12835
12836 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
12837 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
12838 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
12839 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
12840 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
12841 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
12842
12843 ** Text property changes
12844
12845 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
12846 text property.
12847
12848 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
12849 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
12850 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
12851 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
12852 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
12853
12854 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
12855 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
12856 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
12857 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
12858
12859 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
12860 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
12861 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
12862
12863 ** Changes in invisibility features
12864
12865 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
12866 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
12867 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
12868 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
12869 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
12870 make the overlay visible.
12871
12872 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
12873 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
12874 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
12875 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
12876 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
12877 t when it should hide it.
12878
12879 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
12880
12881 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
12882 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
12883 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
12884 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
12885 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
12886 Here is an example of how to do this:
12887
12888 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
12889 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12890 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
12891 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12892
12893 ...
12894 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
12895
12896 ...
12897 ;; When done with the overlays:
12898 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12899 ;; Or respectively:
12900 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12901
12902 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
12903
12904 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
12905 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
12906 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
12907 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
12908
12909 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
12910 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
12911 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
12912
12913 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
12914 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
12915
12916 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
12917 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
12918
12919 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
12920 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
12921 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
12922
12923 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
12924 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
12925 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
12926 determine the syntax type of the character.
12927
12928 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
12929 of the current buffer.
12930
12931 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
12932 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
12933 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
12934
12935 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
12936 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
12937 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
12938 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
12939 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
12940
12941 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
12942 text property.
12943
12944 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
12945 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
12946 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
12947
12948 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
12949 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
12950 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
12951 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
12952 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
12953
12954 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
12955 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
12956 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
12957
12958 ** Changes in face features
12959
12960 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
12961 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
12962
12963 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
12964 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
12965
12966 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
12967 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
12968
12969 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
12970 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
12971
12972 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
12973 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
12974 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
12975 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
12976 overlay property).
12977
12978 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
12979 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
12980
12981 ** Changes in file-handling functions
12982
12983 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
12984 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
12985 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
12986 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
12987
12988 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
12989 begins with ~.
12990
12991 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
12992 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
12993
12994 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
12995 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
12996
12997 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
12998 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
12999
13000 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13001 character code conversion as well as other things.
13002
13003 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13004 (formerly it did not).
13005
13006 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13007 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13008
13009 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13010 instead of constant strings.
13011
13012 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13013 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13014 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13015
13016 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13017 in the same way as before.
13018
13019 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13020 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13021 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13022
13023 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13024 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13025 else, and returns nil.
13026
13027 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13028 directory cannot be listed.
13029
13030 ** Changes in minibuffer input
13031
13032 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13033 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13034 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13035 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13036 ways:
13037
13038 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13039 It is available through the history command M-n.
13040
13041 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13042 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13043 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13044 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13045 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13046
13047 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13048 argument in this way.
13049
13050 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13051 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13052 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13053
13054 ** Echo area features
13055
13056 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13057 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13058 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13059 after the echo area is cleared.
13060
13061 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13062 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13063
13064 ** Keyboard input features
13065
13066 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13067 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13068
13069 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13070 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13071 by keyboard macros.
13072
13073 ** Frame-related changes
13074
13075 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13076 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13077 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13078
13079 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13080 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13081 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13082
13083 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13084 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13085 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13086 in the selected frame.
13087
13088 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13089 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13090 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13091
13092 ** X Windows features
13093
13094 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13095 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13096 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13097
13098 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13099 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13100
13101 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13102 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13103 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13104
13105 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13106 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13107
13108 ** Subprocess features
13109
13110 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13111 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13112 automatically.
13113
13114 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13115 and returns the output from the command as a string.
13116
13117 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13118 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13119
13120 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13121 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13122
13123 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13124 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13125 goes after the other menu items.
13126
13127 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13128 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13129 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13130 are in use.
13131
13132 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13133 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13134
13135 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13136 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13137 form.
13138
13139 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13140 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13141 but its hook is still run.
13142
13143 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13144 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13145
13146 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13147 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13148 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13149
13150 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13151 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13152 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13153 warned.
13154
13155 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13156 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13157
13158 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13159 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13160 functions like display-time.
13161
13162 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13163 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13164
13165 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13166 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13167 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13168
13169 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13170 if there is an error in compilation.
13171
13172 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13173 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13174 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13175 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13176
13177 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13178 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13179 the *scratch* buffer.
13180
13181 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13182 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13183 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13184 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13185
13186 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13187 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13188 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13189
13190 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13191 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13192 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13193 and compose-mail-other-frame.
13194
13195 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13196 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13197 full name of the specified user will be returned.
13198
13199 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13200 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13201 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13202 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13203 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13204 files at all.
13205
13206 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13207 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13208 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13209 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13210
13211 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13212 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13213 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13214 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13215
13216 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13217
13218 ** imenu.el changes.
13219
13220 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13221 item from menu created by imenu.
13222
13223 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13224 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13225 select one of those items.
13226 \f
13227 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
13228
13229 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
13230 Copyright information:
13231
13232 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13233
13234 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13235 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13236 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13237 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13238
13239 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13240 of this document, or of portions of it,
13241 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13242 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
13243 \f
13244 Local variables:
13245 mode: outline
13246 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13247 end:
13248
13249 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793